Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Mercedes-Benz w208 CLK 320 Wis Contents

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 234
At a glance
Powered by AI
The document appears to be a workshop manual covering maintenance and repair procedures for various Mercedes-Benz models, outlining steps for removing and installing over 90 different vehicle parts and systems.

Some of the major components and systems covered include the pushbutton control module, airbags, brake components, engine parts, suspension systems, fuel system parts, electrical components, and interior trim pieces.

Many of the procedures provide numbered steps for removal and installation, including disconnecting electrical connectors, removing mounting hardware, lifting or pulling components out, and reinstalling in the reverse order.

MERCEDESBENZW208CLK320WISCONTENTS

1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
23)
24)
25)
26)
27)
28)
29)
30)
31)
32)
33)
34)
35)
36)
37)
38)
39)
40)
41)
42)
43)
44)
45)
46)
47)
48)

REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGPUSHBUTTONCONTROLMODULE
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGAIRBAGONSTEERINGWHEEL
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGPASSENGERAIRBAGUNIT
INSTALLLEFTFRONTORRIGHTRPMSENSOR
FUNCTIONOFWHEELSPEEDSENSOR
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGACTIVATEDCHARCOALCANISTER
INSTALLLEFTORRIGHTREARAXLESPEEDSENSOR
ESPHYDRAULICUNIT
INSTALLTRANSMISSIONWITHTORQUECONVERTER
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGBASDIAPHRAGMTRAVELSENSOR
BLEEDBRAKESYSTEM
REMOVING,CHECKINGANDINSTALLINGREARAXLEBRAKEPADS
INSTALLFRONTAXLEBRAKEPADS
INSTALLBRAKEDISC
ADJUSTPARKINGBRAKE
INSTALLCAMSHAFTS
INSTALLCRANKSHAFT
INSTALLRADIATOR
REMOVE,INSTALLPOLYVBELT
INSTALLCYLINDERHEADCOVER
VIBRATIONDAMPER
DRIVEPLATE
INSTALLINJECTIONVALVES(MESFI)
INSTALLINTAKEMANIFOLD
INSTALLGENERATORPOLYVBELTPULLEY
INSTALLEXHAUSTMANIFOLD
INSTALLEXHAUSTGASRECIRCULATIONVALVE
REMOVE,INSTALLAIRPUMP
REPLACESPARKPLUGS
INSTALLKNOCKSENSORS
INSTALLCRANKSHAFTPOSITIONSENSOR
INSTALLIGNITIONCOILS
REMOVESTARTER,INSTALL
INSTALLENGINEMOUNT
INSTALLALTERNATOR
ENGINEOILANDFILTERCHANGE
INSTALLCOOLANTPUMP
INSTALLCOOLANTTHERMOSTAT
INSTALLACCELERATORPEDAL
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGTORSIONBARONFRONTAXLE
INSTALLREARSPRING
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGFRONTSPRING
INSTALLREARSUSPENSIONSTRUT
INSTALLFRONTSHOCKABSORBER
INSTALLREARSHOCKABSORBER
INSTALLCOMPLETEREARAXLE
INSTALLPROPELLERSHAFT
REMOVALANDINSTALLATIONOFPROPELLERSHAFTINTERMEDIATEBEARINGANDREPLACEMENTOF
GROOVEDBALLBEARING
1

49)
50)
51)
52)
53)
54)
55)
56)
57)
58)
59)
60)
61)
62)
63)
64)
65)
66)
67)
68)
69)
70)
71)
72)
73)
74)
75)
76)
77)
78)
79)
80)
81)
82)
83)
84)
85)
86)
87)
88)
89)
90)
91)
92)
93)
94)
95)
96)
97)

REPLACEBRAKEFLUID
CARRYINGOUTBLEEDINGOPERATION
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGBRAKEBOOSTER
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGMECHANICALSTOPLAMPSWITCH
SPECIFIEDGEAROILS(CARS,CROSSCOUNTRYVEHICLES)SURVEY
DISMANTLINGANDASSEMBLINGRIGIDJACKETTUBE
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGELECTRONICSTEERINGLOCK
STARTERSWITCH(EZS
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGCONTACTSPIRAL
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGJACKETTUBE
CHECKINGOILPRESSUREOFPOWERSTEERINGPUMP
FILLPOWERSTEERINGPUMPANDBLEED
INSTALLPOWERSTEERINGPUMP
INSTALLSTEERINGIDLERARM,REPLACINGBEARINGBUSH
INSTALLTIERODBALLJOINT
REPLACEFUELFILTER
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGEXPANSIONRESERVOIR
DRAININGANDFILLINGFUELTANK
REMOVE,INSTALLFUELGAGESENSOR
INSTALLFUELTANK
REMOVING,INSTALLINGFUELPUMP
REMOVING,INSTALLINGSHUTOFFVALVE
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGEXHAUSTSYSTEMCOMPLETE
INSTALLTHEOXYGENSENSOR
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGCATALYTICCONVERTERORFRONTEXHAUSTSYSTEM
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGBATTERY
STAMPINGINVEHICLEIDENTIFICATIONNUMBER
VEHICLEIDENTIFICATIONNUMBER
INSTALLFRONTAXLEHALF
INSTALLDRAGLINK
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGFRONTSEATS
INSTALLFRONTDOOR
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGINSTRUMENTPANEL
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGENGINEHOOD
INSTALLFRONTFENDERS
INSTALLWINDSHIELD
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGFRONTBUMPER
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGCOVERBELOWINSTRUMENTPANEL(LEFT)
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGCENTERCONSOLE
ADJUSTFRONTDOOR
STARTERSWITCHCONTROLMODULE
INSTALLBULBSOFHEADLAMPUNIT
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGTELESCOPINGNOZZLEFORHEADLAMPCLEANINGSYSTEM
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGHEADLAMPCLEANINGSYSTEMWASHINGWATERRESERVOIR
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGOVERHEADCONTROLPANELCONTROLMODULE
INSTALLRAINSENSOR
REMOVING,DISASSEMBLINGANDINSTALLINGREARSHELF
VENTILATION
REMOVINGANDINSTALLINGBLOWERMOTOR

AR83.40-P-6350C
Removing and installing pushbutton control module
MODEL
129 as of 1.6.96,
140, 202 as of 1.9.95,
208, 210 with CODE (581a) Air conditioning (automatic)

23.9.96

P83.40-0386-09

Shown on model 129


1

2
Connector
3
Connector
N22 Pushbutton control module

Removal tools

ed
1

Removal, installation
Pull out A/C pushbutton control module
(N22)

i For this purpose insert removal


tools (1)
Press back retaining springs (arrow) on
removed pushbutton control module and pull
out removal tools (1)

Disconnect connectors (2, 3) on A/C


pushbutton control module (N22)

i Unhook connectors by pivoting retaining


strap

Reinstall in opposite order

i Installation
When replacing automatic A/C pushbutton
control module on models 140, 202, 208,
210, version coding must be carried out.

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar83.40-p-6350c, Removing and installing pushbutton control module
MODEL 129 as of 1.6.96, 140, 202 as of 1.9.95, 208, 210 with CODE (581a) Air conditioning (automatic)

Page 1 of 1

AR91.60-P-0660G
MODEL
170, 208

Removing and installing airbag on steering wheel

4.2.10

Illustrated on model 170

P91.60-0407-06

ed

Removal, installation

a Danger!

Injury hazard when testing or repairing


airbags or emergency tensioning retractors

p
p

o
1
2

Store airbags with opening surface pointing AS91.00-Z-0001-01A


up, do not expose to temperatures above
100 C. Interrupt electric circuit when
working on these units
Important instructions for performing repair, Model 129 as of 1.7.93, 163, 168, 170, 202 as AH91.00-P-0002-01B
body work and welding on vehicles with
of 1.7.93, 208, 210, 463, 638, 901, 902, 903,
airbags and emergency tensioning retractors 904
Evaluation of airbags and emergency
Model 129 as of 1.7.93, 163, 168, 170, 202 as AH91.00-P-0006-01B
tensioning retractors on accident vehicles
of 1.7.93, 208, 210, 463, 638, 901, 902, 903,
904
Legal regulations on handling and storing
Models 124, 129, 140, 163, 168, 170, 202, 208,AH91.00-P-0004-01A
airbags and emergency tensioning retractors 210,314, 316, 318, 463, 638, 901, 902, 903,
904, 950, 952, 953, 954
Instructions on disposal of airbags and
All models
OS91.00-P-0001-01A
emergency tensioning retractors
Disconnect ground lead from battery
Unscrew two screws (arrow)
*BA91.60-P-1001-01A
n
i Hold airbag while unscrewing
l

Remove airbag from steering wheel and


disconnect connector from squib on gas
generator
Disconnect horn contacts
Rendering airbags unusable
Install in opposite order

6
7

Check combination switch automatic return


Perform diagnosis

*126589001000

AR91.60-P-0611A
i After the driver's airbag has triggered it is
always necessary to replace the steering
wheel
AD91.60-P-6000A

n Airbag
Number

Designation

BA91.60-P-1001-01A

Screw for airbag on steering wheel

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar91.60-p-0660g, Removing and installing airbag on steering wheel
MODEL 170, 208

Nm

Model 170

Model 208

Page 1 of 2

126 589 00 10 00
Screwdriver attachment

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar91.60-p-0660g, Removing and installing airbag on steering wheel
MODEL 170, 208

Page 2 of 2

AR91.60-P-0680K
MODEL
208
1
R12/8

Removing and installing passenger airbag unit

5.12.96

Bolt
Initiator for front passenger airbag
(AB)

P91.60-0513-04

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of injury when carrying out test or


repair work on airbag or emergency
tensioning retractor units

Important instructions for performing repair,


body work and welding on vehicles with
airbags and emergency tensioning retractor
units
Legal regulations concerning the handling
and storage of airbag and emergency
tensioning retractors
Notes on disposal of airbag and emergency
tensioning retractors
Disconnect ground cable of battery
Remove instrument panel
Disconnect connector from the initiator
(R12/8) at the inflator

o
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8

Unscrew nut (2) for front passenger airbag


unit
Remove front passenger airbag unit
Make airbag units unusable
Install in the reverse order
Carry out diagnosis.

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar91.60-p-0680k, Removing and installing passenger airbag unit
MODEL 208

Store airbag unit with expulsion area on top,


do not subject to temperatures above 100
C. Interrupt power supply when working on
such units.
Models 129 as of 1.7.93, 163, 168, 170, 202
as of 1.7.93, 208, 210, 463, 638, 901, 902,
903, 904

AS91.00-Z-0001-01A

AH91.00-P-0002-01B

Models 124, 129, 140, 163, 168, 170, 202, 208,AH91.00-P-0004-01A


210, 314, 316, 318, 463, 638, 901, 902, 903,
904, 950, 952, 953, 954
All models
OS91.00-P-0001-01A
AR54.10-P-0003A
AR68.10-P-1000K
i Installation: Connector must audibly
latch into position

AR91.60-P-0611A

AD91.60-P-6000A

Page 1 of 1

AR42.30-P-0712A
Remove/install left front or right rpm sensor
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 203, 208, 210

8.12.11

P42.30-0238-06

Modification notes
29.11.11

Long-life grease repair materials replaced by hot-grease


paste

Fig. item etc.


L6/1a, L6/2a
L6/1, L6/2

Work instructions
Self-locking hexagon socket head bolts for
rpm sensor
Front rpm sensor

Front axle rpm sensor mounting changed

L6/1b, L6/2b

Centering sleeve

n p Replace bolts.

*BA42.30-P-1001-01A

i Installation:
Check rotor on wheel hub for signs of
damage. Pay attention to cleanliness of
magnetic tip.
models 202, 210:
p Rpm sensors from Bosch and Teves
cannot be installed together.
Model 202 as of 09.95

BT42.30-P-0001-01A

p Replace centering sleeve.


Model 202
iAs of 9.95
Apply light coating of grease to steering
knuckle.
Hot lubricating paste

*BR00.45-Z-1005-06A

n Front axle rpm sensor


Number

Designation

BA42.30-P-1001-01A

Self-locking bolt, front axle rpm sensor to


steering knuckle

Nm

Model 129

Model 140

Model 170

Model 202

Model 203

22

22

22

22

25

Model 208

Model 210

n Front axle rpm sensor


Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.30-p-0712a, Remove/install left front or right rpm sensor
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 203, 208, 210

Page 1 of 2

BA42.30-P-1001-01A

Self-locking bolt, front axle rpm sensor to


steering knuckle

Nm

22

22

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1005-06A

Designation
Paste, hot lubrication 1 kg, DB supply specification 6879.20

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.30-p-0712a, Remove/install left front or right rpm sensor
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 203, 208, 210

Order number
A 000 989 76 51

Page 2 of 2

GF42.45-P-4550A
Location / task / design / function of wheel speed sensor
MODEL
129,
140, 202 as of 1.6.94,
163, 168, 170, 208, 210
with CODE (470a) Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
with CODE (212a) Electronic traction system (ETS)
with CODE (471a) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR)
MODEL
129,
140 as of 1.6.94,
163 up to 31.8.02,
168, 170, 210 with CODE (472a) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)
MODEL
202 with ENGINES 112, 113, 604 with CODE (472a) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)
MODEL
208 with ENGINES 112, 113 with CODE (472a) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)
L6/1
L6/2

13.5.96

Left front wheel speed sensor


Right front wheel speed sensor

ABS only
L6
Rear axle speed sensor
ETS, ASR, ESP only
L6/3
Left rear wheel speed sensor
L6/4
Right rear wheel speed sensor

P42.30-0221-06

Wheel speed sensor, location

Wheel speed sensor, task

Wheel speed sensor, design

Wheel speed sensor, function

The front wheelspeed sensors (L6/1 and


L6/2) are mounted on the front steering
knuckle assemblies.
ABS: The rear wheelspeed sensor (L6) is
located on the differential assembly.
ETS, ASR, ESP: The rear wheelspeed
sensors (L6/3 and L6/4) are mounted on the
rear wheel carriers.
To supply the current wheel speed to the
ABS, ETS, ASR or ESP control module
(N47-7, N47-2, N47-1 or N47-5).
Inductive sensor: Coil with magnetic core
installed at a defined distance from reluctor
on the front wheel hub, the rear halfshafts or
the drive pinion at the rear axle.
The magnetic field of the wheel speed
sensor is intersected by the teeth of a rotor.
This changes the magnetic field and the coil
induces an AC voltage. The frequency of
this alternating current, governed by the
number of teeth on the reluctor, fluctuates
to reflect variations in wheelspeed, is
proportional to wheelspeed.

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, gf42.45-p-4550a, Location / task / design / function of wheel speed sensor
Page 1 of 1
MODEL 129, 140, 202 as of 1.6.94, 163, 168, 170, 208, 210 with CODE (470a) Anti-lock brake system (ABS) with CODE (212a) Electronic traction system (ETS) with CODE (471a) Acceleration ...

AR47.30-P-8212DA
Removing and installing activated charcoal canister
MODEL
202, 208 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version
77

Activated charcoal canister

Y58/4

Activated charcoal canister shutoff


valve
Hose clips

82/4
A

B
C

18.12.97

Activated charcoal canister line to


purge control valve
Activated charcoal canister line to
reservoir
Activated charcoal canister line to
shutoff valve

P47.30-2010-06

ed

Removing, installing

a Danger!

Risk of explosion from ignition. Risk of


poisoning from inhaling and swallowing fuel.
Risk of injury as a result of fuel coming into
contact with skin and eyes.
Remove wheel housing liner
Detach lines (arrow) at shutoff valve (58/4)
Slacken hose clips (82/4) and detach lines
(A) and (B)
Remove activated charcoal canister (77)

1
2
3
4

No fire, naked flame or smoking.


AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
Rear left

i On-board refuelling vapor recovery


ORVR function
5

GF47.10-P-3004A

Install in the reverse order

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar47.30-p-8212da, Removing and installing activated charcoal canister
MODEL 202, 208 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version

10

Page 1 of 1

AR42.40-P-0820A
Remove/install left or right rear axle speed sensor
MODEL
129, 140 as of 1.6.94,
170,
202 as of 1.6.94,
208, 210
with CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR)
with CODE (212) Electronic traction system (ETS)
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210 with CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)
MODEL
203
MODEL
209 except CODE (P98) Black Series

8.12.11

Shows model 202

P42.40-0218-06

Modification notes
29.11.11

Long-life grease repair materials replaced by hot-grease


paste

Fig. item etc.


a

L6/3, L6/4

Work instructions
Self-locking bolts securing rear axle rpm
sensor

Left/right rear axle rpm sensor

p Installation: Replace bolts in order to


prevent them from becoming loose.
n Models 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210,

*BA42.40-P-1002-01A

n Model 203, 209

*BA42.30-P-1001-02A

i Installation: Check rotor on wheel hub


for damage. Pay attention to cleanliness of
magnetic tip.
i Installation: Apply light coating of grease
to bore in wheel carrier.
Hot lubricating paste
*BR00.45-Z-1005-06A

n Acceleration Slip Regulation (ASR)


Number

Designation

BA42.40-P-1002-01A

Self-locking bolt, rear axle speed sensor

Nm

Model 129

Model 140

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

Model 210

n Acceleration Slip Regulation (ASR)


Number

Designation

11

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.40-p-0820a, Remove/install left or right rear axle speed sensor
Page 1 of 2
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 170, 202 as of 1.6.94, 208, 210 with CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) with CODE (212) Electronic traction system (ETS) MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, ...

BA42.40-P-1002-01A

Self-locking bolt, rear axle speed sensor

Nm

n Rear axle rpm sensor


Number

Designation

BA42.30-P-1001-02A

Self-locking bolt of rear axle rpm sensor to wheel


carrier

Nm

Model 203

Model 209

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1005-06A

Designation
Paste, hot lubrication 1 kg, DB supply specification 6879.20

Order number
A 000 989 76 51

12

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.40-p-0820a, Remove/install left or right rear axle speed sensor
Page 2 of 2
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 170, 202 as of 1.6.94, 208, 210 with CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) with CODE (212) Electronic traction system (ETS) MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, ...

AR42.40-P-0816A
Remove/install ETS/ASR/ESP hydraulic unit
MODEL
129, 140 as of 1.6.94,
170,
202 as of 1.6.94,
208, 210
with CODE (212) Electronic traction system (ETS)
with CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR)
MODEL
129, 140, 210 with CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)
MODEL
202, 208 with ENGINE 112, 113 with CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)

13.1.10

Connectors of ESP hydraulic unit


(A7/3)
VA
RA
VL
FR
RL
RR
m1

to front axle connector of charging piston unit


to rear axle connector of charging piston unit
To left front wheel brake
To right front wheel brake
To left rear wheel brake
To right rear wheel brake
High-pressure/return pump

P42.45-0205-02

Connectors of Teves hydraulic unit


ASR/ETS (A7/3)
VL
FR
RL
RR
V
H

To left front wheel brake


To right front wheel brake
To left rear wheel brake
To right rear wheel brake
to tandem master brake cylinder of front axle
to tandem master brake cylinder of rear axle

P42.40-0298-02

13

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.40-p-0816a, Remove/install ETS/ASR/ESP hydraulic unit


Page 1 of 3
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 170, 202 as of 1.6.94, 208, 210 with CODE (212) Electronic traction system (ETS) with CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 129, 140, 210 with ...

Connectors of hydraulic unit, Bosch


ASR V/ETS (A7/3)
V
H
VL
FR
RL
RR

to tandem master brake cylinder of


front axle
to tandem master brake cylinder of
rear axle
To left front wheel brake
To right front wheel brake
To left rear wheel brake
To right rear wheel brake

P42.40-0211-06

Figure item, etc.

Work instructions
Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake appropriately marked containers. Wear
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes. protective clothing and eye protection when
handling brake fluid.
Brake fluid notes

Notes on repairs to brake system

Ignition OFF

i Following
completion of
installation

Bleed brake system

AR42.10-P-0010A

i Following
completion of
installation

Read out fault memory and erase

AD00.00-P-1000AZ

a Danger!

AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

AH42.50-P-0001-01A
AH42.00-P-0003-01A

a
Hydraulic lines

l Ring spanner insert with size 11 mm.

*000589750300

l Ring spanner insert with size 12 mm.

*140589000300

n (ASR/ETS)

*BA42.40-P-1001-01A

n (ESP)
Model 202, 208

*BA42.45-P-1003-01A
*BA42.45-P-1003-01B

p Risk of confusion! Before unbolting, mark


hydraulic line at appropriate connector.
p l Use plugs to seal off hydraulic lines
and connection fittings.

*129589009100

p Installation: Pay attention to the


markings when screwing on the hydraulic
lines. Do not misconnect hydraulic lines. If
necessary check installation of lines to the
appropriate wheel.
a

Plastic caps

i Installation: Install with the lug


downwards.

A7/3

Hydraulic unit (ETS)

i Model 170: pull out upwards out of the


rubber plugs.

n Acceleration Slip Regulation (ASR)


Number

Designation

Model 129

Model 140

Model 202

Model 210

14

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.40-p-0816a, Remove/install ETS/ASR/ESP hydraulic unit


Page 2 of 3
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 170, 202 as of 1.6.94, 208, 210 with CODE (212) Electronic traction system (ETS) with CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 129, 140, 210 with ...

BA42.40-P-1001-01A

Brake line to ASR / ETS hydraulic unit

Nm

15

15

15

15

n Acceleration Slip Regulation (ASR)


Number

Designation

BA42.40-P-1001-01A

Brake line to ASR / ETS hydraulic unit

Nm

Model 170

Model 208

15

15

n Electronic Stability Program (ESP)


Number

Designation

BA42.45-P-1003-01A

Brake line to ESP hydraulic unit

Nm

Model 129

Model 140

Model 210

15

15

15

n Electronic Stability Program (ESP)


Number

Designation

Model
208 with
engine
111

BA42.45-P-1003-01B

Union nut, brake line to ESP hydraulic unit

M10 1

Nm

14

M12 1

Nm

16

n Electronic Stability Program (ESP)


Number

Designation

BA42.45-P-1003-01B

Union nut, brake line to ESP hydraulic unit

000 589 75 03 00
Box wrench bit

129 589 00 91 00
Set of stop plugs

Model
202 with
engines
112, 113

Model
208 with
engine
112, 113

M10 1

Nm

14

14

M12 1

Nm

16

16

140 589 00 03 00
Box wrench bit

15

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.40-p-0816a, Remove/install ETS/ASR/ESP hydraulic unit


Page 3 of 3
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 170, 202 as of 1.6.94, 208, 210 with CODE (212) Electronic traction system (ETS) with CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 129, 140, 210 with ...

AR27.10-P-0500B
Remove/install transmission with torque converter
TRANSMISSION
722.6 in MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

30.4.09

P27.10-0251-09

4
9
26
33
46
49

Oil drain screw, transmission oil pan


Torque converter oil drain screw
Plug-in connector
Range selector lever
Ground strap
Oil cooling lines

61
62
63
64
65

Oil filler pipe


Shield
Shift rod
Exhaust bracket
Engine support with engine mount

66
80
81
94
95

Propeller shaft
Parking shift lock
Torque converter cover
Exhaust system
Screw

Modification notes
13.1.06

Oil drain bolt to torque converter


Bolt, torque converter to drive plate

Transmission 722.6
Transmission 722.6

*BA27.20-P-1001-01C
*BA27.20-P-1002-01C

ed

Remove/install

Notes on self-locking nuts and bolts

AH00.00-N-0001-01A

Before starting work the area around the oil


cooler lines (49) must be thoroughly cleaned
in the separation point areas on the
transmission. Even the smallest dirt particles,
introduced into the hydraulic components,
can lead to malfunctions and a total failure
of the transmission
Detach ground line from battery
p Insulate ground line as a protection
against unintentional contact of detached
ground line with ground point of battery.
Model 129, 170, 202, 208, 210
Model 140
Notes on battery

AR54.10-P-0003A
ra54001400003x
AH54.10-P-0001-01A

Detach oil filler pipe (61) from engine

Model 129, 140 with engine 119


Model 202, 210 with engine 111, 604, 605,
606
Models 129, 140 with engine 120
Model 210 with engine 119

AR27.10-P-0500-04A

*BA27.10-P-1001-03A

p
2.1

2.2

Remove oil filler pipe (61)

Remove oil drain screw (4) from the


transmission oil pan and drain transmission
oil

i If the transmission oil is burnt or


interspersed with abrasive particles, the oil
cooler lines (49) and oil cooler must be
flushed out:
Flush oil cooler and oil cooling lines
4

Remove oil drain screw (9) from torque


converter and drain transmission oil

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar27.10-p-0500b, Remove/install transmission with torque converter
TRANSMISSION 722.6 in MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

AR27.10-P-0500-04A

AR27.55-P-0001A
*BA27.20-P-1001-01C

16

Page 1 of 4

k
5.1
6

Oil drain screw (9) at torque converter no


longer required
Remove shield (62) and detach 13-pin plug
(26)
Detach control cable / gears for parking lock
interlock (80) from transmission

p If the transmission oil pan contains metal


shavings, drain the transmission fluid from
the torque converter via the drain hole
through a clean cloth.
If the cloth contains metal swarf after
draining the transmission oil, it is then
necessary to replace the torque converter.
In case of doubt, flush the torque converter
with ATF only.
Metal shavings can damage the
transmission at a later stage.
Transmission 722.6

BT27.20-P-0001-01A

Shield (62) discontinued on model 129 with


engine 119 and engine 120 as of 03.96

AR27.10-P-0500-01A

i Transmission models
722.620 up to end no. 0001680
722.621 up to end no. 0001976
722.622 up to end no. 0016286

AR27.60-P-0500-05A

i Transmission models
722.60/61/63/66/69
722.620 as of end no. 0001681
722.621 as of end no. 0001977
722.622 as of end no. 0016287
722.623/624/625/627/628/629

AR27.60-P-0500-05B

p To install and remove place the selector


lever or range selector lever (33) in
position"P" and leave in position "P" with the
cable/transmission removed.

7.1

Detach retaining plate for rack-and-pinion


steering

Remove cover (81) and unscrew bolts (95)


from torque converter
Detach left and right oil cooling line (49) on
transmission
Remove shift rod (63); to do this, remove
securing clips using l pliers

9
10

11
12.1
12.2
13
14

Remove exhaust bracket (64).


Detach exhaust system (94) at rear with Vbelt
Remove exhaust system (94) as from
connector
Remove fan shroud from radiator
Remove engine support with rear engine
mount (65)

g Installation: Check function of parking


shift lock (80).
Model 210 4MATIC
See:
Remove/install rack-and-pinion steering.
n

AR46.20-P-0600A
*BA27.20-P-1002-01C

l Pliers

*210589003700

i Installation: Adjust shift rod (63).

AR27.60-P-0980B

Model 129, 140, 210 with engine 119


Models 129, 140 with engine 120

AR49.10-P-7000F

Model 210 with engine 119


Model 140 with engine 606
Engine 112, 113

AR22.10-P-1160HV

Engine 119
Engine 120
Model 202, 210 with engine 111, 604, 605,
606
Model 202, 210 with Engine 611, 612, 613

ra22001192120x
AR22.10-P-1160AO
AR22.10-P-1160HB

15

Detach front propeller shaft (66)

AR22.10-P-1160HC
*BA41.10-P-1001-01A

16.1

Detach propeller shaft from transfer case

n Model 210 4MATIC

*BA33.30-P-1003-02A

17
18

Detach ground strap (46) from transmission


Unscrew transmission from crankcase and
use k transmission platform to remove
downwards at an angle

p Secure torque converter to prevent it


from falling out.

19.1

Remove torque converter using l grab


handles

If necessary

AR27.20-P-0500-01B

i Installation: Grease the torque converter


lightly on drive flange.
Multipurpose paste
*BR00.45-Z-1009-06A
*168589006200
l
20
21
22
23.1

Install in the reverse order


Check oil level in automatic transmission,
correct if necessary
Read out fault memory with STAR
DIAGNOSIS and erase if necessary
Perform transmission adaptation

AR27.00-P-0100AC

Transmission adaptation must be performed


after the transmission is changed or repaired.

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar27.10-p-0500b, Remove/install transmission with torque converter
TRANSMISSION 722.6 in MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

17

Page 2 of 4

a Danger!

24

Risk of accident caused by vehicle starting


off by itself when engine is running. Risk of
injury caused by contusions and burns
during starting procedure or when working
near the engine as it is running
Perform engine test run and check
transmission for proper function and
leaktightness.

Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving by


itself.
Wear closed and snug-fitting work clothes.
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.

AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

n Torque converter
Number

Designation

BA27.20-P-1001-01C

Oil drain bolt to torque


converter

BA27.20-P-1002-01C

Bolt, torque converter


to drive plate

Transmission
722.6
except
722.648

M8

Nm

10

M10

Nm

15

Straight threaded
connection

M8

Nm

42

Angled threaded
connection

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Nm

30

Stage 3

90

n Oil pan, automatic transmission


Number

Designation

BA27.10-P-1001-03A

Drain plug on transmission oil pan

Transmission
722.6
except
722.628/
648/649

Nm

20

n Front axle shaft


Number

Designation

BA33.30-P-1003-02A

Bolt, front axle gear propeller shaft


to transfer case flange

Model
210.08/28

Nm

30

n Propeller shaft
Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar27.10-p-0500b, Remove/install transmission with torque converter
TRANSMISSION 722.6 in MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Model
129

Model
140

Model
170

18

Page 3 of 4

BA41.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut, flexible coupling to transmission


or front propeller shaft

M10

Nm

40

40

M12

Nm

60

60

60

Model
202

Model
208

Model
210

n Propeller shaft
Number

Designation

BA41.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut, flexible coupling to transmission


or front propeller shaft

168 589 00 62 00

M10

Nm

40

40

40

M12

Nm

60

60

60

210 589 00 37 00

Grab handle

Pliers

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1009-06A

Designation
Multipurpose paste

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar27.10-p-0500b, Remove/install transmission with torque converter
TRANSMISSION 722.6 in MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Order number
A 000 989 80 51 10

19

Page 4 of 4

AR42.31-P-6002A
Removing and installing BAS diaphragm travel sensor
MODEL
129, 140 as of 1.12.96,
170, 202 as of 1.6.97,
208, 210 as of 1.2.97

7.9.96

Shown on model 208


8
16b

Vacuum line
Locking ring

A7/7b1
A7/7x1

BAS diaphragm travel sensor


Diaphragm travel sensor connector

P42.31-0253-11

Shown on model 210


8
16b

Vacuum line
Locking ring

A7/7b1
A7/7x1

BAS diaphragm travel sensor


Diaphragm travel sensor connector

P42.31-0216-11

Modification notes
1.8.99

Check diaphragm travel sensor for labeling

ed

Removing, installing

i
1

Notes on brake booster

2
3

Operate brake pedal several times until


vacuum in brake booster is reduced.

Unplug BAS diaphragm travel sensor


connector (A7/7x1)
Remove locking ring (16b)

i New parts are marked with a white,


yellow or blue "D" (Figure 1). The label may
be on the side away from you.

AH43.20-P-0001-01A
p The diaphragm travel sensor sealing ring
may be sucked into the brake booster if
vacuum is present.
If this happens, the brake booster must be
replaced.

Use a suitable tool, e.g. angled scriber


(arrow).
i Installation: Replace locking ring and
ensure that it is correctly seated.
p Different manufacturers use different
locking rings.

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.31-p-6002a, Removing and installing BAS diaphragm travel sensor
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.12.96, 170, 202 as of 1.6.97, 208, 210 as of 1.2.97

20

Page 1 of 2

Pull out BAS diaphragm travel sensor


(A7/7b1)

i Installation: Rub a little spirit or soapy


water onto the front of the diaphragm travel
sensor so that O-ring slides correctly when
inserted.

Replace O-ring

i Installation: Insert O-ring into groove in


brake booster and ensure that it is correctly
seated.

Install in the reverse order


Checking

g
7
8
9

Start engine
Switch off engine
Check diaphragm travel sensor for leaks

i Operate brake several times.


i There must not be any air flow noises
audible at the brake booster.

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.31-p-6002a, Removing and installing BAS diaphragm travel sensor
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.12.96, 170, 202 as of 1.6.97, 208, 210 as of 1.2.97

21

Page 2 of 2

AR42.10-P-0010A
Bleed brake system
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

10.11.11

P42.10-0270-09

a Danger!

p
p
1

y
2

Bleeding
Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake appropriately marked containers. Wear
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes. protective clothing and eye protection when
handling brake fluid.
Brake fluid notes
Notes on repairs to brake system
Actuate master brake cylinder switchover
valve (Y61)

Wiring harness for actuation of switchover


valve
Connect brake fluid changing equipment

Carrying out bleeding operation

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010a, Bleed brake system


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

AH42.50-P-0001-01A
AH42.00-P-0003-01A

Model 129.076, 140.04/05/06/07

AR42.10-P-0010-01A

i The switchover valve (Y61) must be


opened so that the annular passage in the
master brake cylinder is bled.
Model 129.067 with ESP

WF58.50-P-4210-01A

l Electrical connection set

*201589009900

p Pay attention to manufacturer's operating


instructions.
i Bleeding pressure 2 bar.
Brake fluid change unit
gotis://B_42/43.2_01
j Brake fluid
Model 129, 140 without code 471 ASR,
without code 472 ESP
Models 129, 140 with code 471 ASR and
ETS as of 1. 6. 94
Model 129.059/064/068 with/without ESP
with engine 112, 113
Model 170
Model 202 without code 471 ASR up to
31.5.94
Model 202 with code 471 ASR as of 1.6.94
Model 202 with ESP
Model 208
Model 210 without ESP, model 210 with ESP,
except model 210.072/272 with ESP
Model 129 with ASR (code 471a) up to
31.5.94
Model 140 with ASR (code 471a) up to
31.5.94
Model 202 with ASR (code 471a) up to
31.5.94
Model 129.067/076, 140 with ESP,
Model 210.072/272 with ESP

*BF42.10-P-1001-01A
AR42.10-P-0010-02A

AR42.10-P-0010-02B
AR42.10-P-0010-02C
AR42.10-P-0010-02D
AR42.10-P-0010-02E
22

Page 1 of 5

Front axle, model 129, 140:

Disconnect the brake fluid changing


equipment, check the brake fluid level and
correct if necessary

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 170:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10I

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 202:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10P

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 208:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10K

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 210:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10D

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle, model 129, 140:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10F

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 170:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12I

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 202:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12P

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 208:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12K

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 210:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12D

n Bleed screw to brake caliper

*BA42.10-P-1001-12F

l Socket wrench

*140589030900

j Brake fluid

*BF42.10-P-1001-01A

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10I

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
129

Model
140
without
special
protection

Model
140 with
special
protectio
n

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10P

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
170

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010a, Bleed brake system


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Model
202.018/020/
022/023/033/
078/080/081/
083/087/093/
120/121/122/
125/133/134/
180/182/193/
194,
Model
202.028
up to 08/95

Model
202.024/025/
026/029/082/
085/086/088/
089/128/188,
Model
202.028
as of 09/95

23

Page 2 of 5

BA42.10-P-1002-10K

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10D

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
208

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10F

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
210

M8

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12I

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
129

Model
140

Model
170.435/
444/445/
447/449/
465

Model
170.466

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12P

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12K

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
202

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010a, Bleed brake system


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Model
208
24

Page 3 of 5

BA42.10-P-1002-12D

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Model
210

BA42.10-P-1001-12F

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

j Brake fluid
Number

Designation

BF42.10-P-1001-01A

Brake fluid

Model
129

Model
140

Filling capacity

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

Model
170

Model
202

0.45 to 0.6

0.7...0.9

j Brake fluid
Number

Designation

BF42.10-P-1001-01A

Brake fluid

Filling capacity

Liters

0.45 to 0.6

0.45 to 0.6

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

Model
208

Model
210

j Brake fluid
Number

Designation

BF42.10-P-1001-01A

Brake fluid

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010a, Bleed brake system


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Filling capacity

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

0.45 to 0.6

0.45 to 0.6

25

Page 4 of 5

201 589 00 99 00
Electrical connection set

140 589 03 09 00
Socket wrench

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010a, Bleed brake system


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

26

Page 5 of 5

AR42.10-P-1700AM
Removing, checking and installing rear axle brake pads
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

11.3.10

P42.10-0242-09

Fixed brake caliper with two retaining pins (41) on rear axle

P42.10-0425-09

Fixed brake caliper with one retaining pin (41) on rear axle
Remove/install
ed
a Danger!

a Danger!
p

Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing


Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake appropriately marked containers. Wear
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes. protective clothing and eye protection when
handling brake fluid.
Risk of injury to skin and eyes caused by
Wear safety gloves, protective clothing and
handling hot or glowing objects.
safety glasses, if necessary.
Notes on repairs to brake system

p
1

Brake fluid notes

Remove rear wheels


Remove/install wheels, rotate if necessary

Unscrew the cap on the brake fluid


expansion reservoir and suction off some
brake fluid

AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

AS00.00-Z-0002-01A
AH42.00-P-0003-01A
AH42.50-P-0001-01A

i In order to prevent the expansion


reservoir overflowing when pressing back the
brake pistons (47)

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-1700am, Removing, checking and installing rear axle brake pads
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

AP40.10-P-4050Z
27

Page 1 of 3

Remove brake pad contact sensor

Notes on installing brake pad wear sensor


contact sensors
Drive out retaining pins (41) using punch
(035) and remove retaining spring

4
5

Pull brake pads (43) out of the brake caliper


(31)

i Installation: Replace defective brake pad


contact sensor.
AH42.10-P-0003-01A
i Installation: Knock retaining pins (41) all
the way in.
p When pressing out seized brake pads
(43) insert wedge between lever (034) and
brake caliper (31) to prevent damage.
i Brake pads (43) are to be disposed of as
special waste. The local authorities can
provide information regarding whether
disposal is also permitted as industrial waste
similar to domestic waste.
i Installation: Only sets of brake pads
(43) approved by Mercedes-Benz may be
installed. Install brake pads (43) with
peripheral damping (a and c) ungreased. On
brake pads (43) without peripheral damping
on the side surfaces (arrows) coat with some
brake pad paste.

g
6

Checking

e
e

Inspect condition of brake disks

Check brake pad thickness and brake disks

Check brake lining thickness

l Lever

*123589133300

l Wedge
Brake pad paste

*601589076300
*BR00.45-Z-1003-06A

i Replace brake pads (43) and brake disks


in sets if necessary.
AP42.10-P-4258AM
Model 129, 140 as of 1.7.93
Model 170, 202, 208, 210

AP42.10-P-4253AM

i If the brake pads (43) have worn down to


beyond the wear limit, the bar between the
sealing groove and dust cap may be
damaged; therefore:
Inspect brake system for leaks with pressure AR42.10-P-0015A
tester.
7

Press back brake piston (47) using resetting


device (031)

i Do not bend heat shield. If brake pads


(43) have been removed from several brake
calipers (31), their brake pistons (47) must
be secured beforehand with wedges to
prevent them from falling out .
i Do not fit the pusher tool (031) to the
brake disk, but push back the opposite brake
pistons (47) simultaneously. If brake pistons
(47) are sluggish:
Repair brake caliper (31).
AR42.10-P-0151A
*000589524300
l Resetting device
l Wedge

m
8

*601589076300

Clean
Clean contact surfaces of brake pads (43)
using brake caliper brush (030)

9
a Danger!

10
g
11

Install in the reverse order


Risk of accident when commissioning the
vehicle due to a lack of braking effect when
the service brake is operated for the first
time after repair work
Operate the brake pedal several times until
the brake pads (43) contact the brake disks

i Do not damage boots of brake pistons


(47).
l Brake caliper brush

*000589266800

Before starting engine, actuate brake pedal


several times until the pressure is built up
and maintained in the brake system.

AS42.50-Z-0002-01A

i Firm resistance should be noticeable at


the brake pedal.

Checking

123 589 13 33 00

Check brake fluid level, correct if necessary


Brake system - inspect fluid level

000 589 26 68 00

Lever
Brake caliper brush
Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-1700am, Removing, checking and installing rear axle brake pads
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

AP42.10-P-4210Z

000 589 52 43 00
Pusher tool

601 589 07 63 00
Wedge

28

Page 2 of 3

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1003-06A

Designation
Brake pad paste replaced by: A 001 989 94 51

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-1700am, Removing, checking and installing rear axle brake pads
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Order number
A 001 989 10 51

29

Page 3 of 3

AR42.10-P-1600BM
Remove/check/install front axle brake pads
7.2.08
MODEL
170.435 /444 /445 /447 /449 /465, 202.024 /025 /026 /029 /082 /085 /086 /088 /089 /128 /188, 208.335 /344 /345
/347 /348 /365 /435 /444 /445 /447 /448 /465
MODEL
202.028 as of 1.9.95,
210.00 /01 /02 /035 /037 /04 /05 /06 /081 /082,
210.083 up to 7.2.99,
210.20 /21 /22 /23 /24 /26 /282,
210.283 up to 7.2.99,
210.60 /61 /663 except CODE (957) AMG engineering package
MODEL
210.070
with CODE (491) USA version
with CODE (498) Japan version
with CODE (625) Australia version
MODEL
208.370 /470 with CODE (491) USA version

P42.10-0268-09

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing


Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake appropriately marked containers. Wear
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes. protective clothing and eye protection when
handling brake fluid.
Risk of injury to skin and eyes caused by
Wear safety gloves, protective clothing and
handling hot or glowing objects.
safety glasses, if necessary.
Notes on repairs to brake system

Brake fluid notes

AH42.50-P-0001-01A

p
1

Notes on self-locking nuts and bolts

AH00.00-N-0001-01A

Remove the front wheels


Remove/install wheels, rotate if necessary

3
4

Unhook spring (31d)


Remove brake pad contact sensor

Notes on installing brake pad wear sensor


contact sensors
Detach covers (31b) and remove guide pins
(31c)

a Danger!

Unscrew the cap on the brake fluid


expansion reservoir and suction off some
brake fluid

AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

AS00.00-Z-0002-01A
AH42.00-P-0003-01A

i In order to prevent the expansion


reservoir overflowing when pressing back the
brake pistons.
AP40.10-P-4050Z
i Installation: Replace defective contact
sensors.
AH42.10-P-0003-01A
n Model 208

*BA42.10-P-1003-10D

n Model 210

*BA42.10-P-1003-10F

n Model 170

*BA42.10-P-1003-10P

n Model 202

*BA42.10-P-1003-10K

30

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-1600bm, Remove/check/install front axle brake pads
Page 1 of 3
MODEL 170.435 /444 /445 /447 /449 /465, 202.024 /025 /026 /029 /082 /085 /086 /088 /089 /128 /188, 208.335 /344 /345 /347 /348 /365 /435 /444 /445 /447 /448 /465 MODEL 202.028 as of 1.9.95, ...

Remove floating brake caliper (31a) with


inner brake pad

p Attach floating caliper (31a) to vehicle so


that it is free of tension. Do not kink or
tension brake hose, as otherwise it will be
damaged.

Remove brake pads (31g)

i Brake pads (31g) are to be disposed of


as special waste. The local authorities can
provide information regarding whether
disposal is also permitted as industrial waste
similar to domestic waste.
i Installation: Only the brake pads (31g)
approved by Mercedes-Benz may be built-in
as a set. Install brake pads (31g) without
grease. Insert inner brake pad with riveted
on spring (arrow) in brake piston, insert
outer brake pad in brake caliper support
(33).

g
8

Checking

e
e

Inspect condition of brake disks


Check brake lining thickness

i If the brake pads (31g) have worn down AP42.10-P-4253AM


to beyond the wear limit, the bar between
the sealing groove and dust cap may be
damaged; therefore:
Inspect brake system for leaks with pressure AR42.10-P-0015A
tester.

Check floating caliper (31a) for leaks and


dust boot (47) for signs of damage and
correct seating

i If floating brake caliper (31a) is leaky or


dust boot (47) is damaged or not seated
correctly:
Repair floating caliper:
Except model 170.444/449/465,
Model 202.088,
Model 208.344/348/444/448
Model 170.444/449/465,
Model 202.088,
Model 208.344/348/444/448

10

Check brake pad thickness and brake disks

Press back brake piston using resetting


device (031).

m
11

Clean

12

Install in the reverse order


Risk of accident when commissioning the
vehicle due to a lack of braking effect when
the service brake is operated for the first
time after repair work
Operate the brake pedal several times until
the brake pads (31g) contact the brake disks

a Danger!

13
14

Clean contact surfaces of brake pads (31g)


at floating caliper (31a) and brake caliper
support (33)

i Only replace brake pads (31g) and brake


disks in complete sets if necessary.
AP42.10-P-4258AM

p If brake pads (31g) have been removed


from several brake calipers, secure their
brake pistons beforehand with wedges to
prevent them from falling out . If the brake
piston is difficult to move:
Repair floating caliper:
Except model 170.444/449/465,
Model 202.088,
Model 208.344/348/444/448
Model 170.444/449/465,
model 202.088,
model 208.344/348/444/448

AR42.10-P-0152B

AR42.10-P-0152B

l Resetting device

*000589524300

l Wedge

*601589076300

i Do not damage dust boot (47).


l Brake caliper brush

*000589266800

Before starting engine, actuate brake pedal


several times until the pressure is built up
and maintained in the brake system.

AS42.50-Z-0002-01A

i Firm resistance should be noticeable at


the brake pedal.

Inspect fluid level in expansion reservoir,


adjust to correct level if necessary
Brake system - inspect fluid level

AP42.10-P-4210Z

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Model
170

31

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-1600bm, Remove/check/install front axle brake pads
Page 2 of 3
MODEL 170.435 /444 /445 /447 /449 /465, 202.024 /025 /026 /029 /082 /085 /086 /088 /089 /128 /188, 208.335 /344 /345 /347 /348 /365 /435 /444 /445 /447 /448 /465 MODEL 202.028 as of 1.9.95, ...

BA42.10-P-1003-10P

Guide pin, brake caliper to brake caliper support

Nm

25

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Model
202.024/025/
026/029/082/
085/086/088/
089/128/188,
Model
202.028
as of 09/95

BA42.10-P-1003-10K

Guide pin on caliper support

Nm

25

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Model
208

BA42.10-P-1003-10D

Guide pin on caliper support

Nm

25

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1003-10F

Guide pin on caliper support

000 589 52 43 00
Pusher tool

Model
210

601 589 07 63 00
Wedge

Nm

25

000 589 26 68 00
Brake caliper brush

32

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-1600bm, Remove/check/install front axle brake pads
Page 3 of 3
MODEL 170.435 /444 /445 /447 /449 /465, 202.024 /025 /026 /029 /082 /085 /086 /088 /089 /128 /188, 208.335 /344 /345 /347 /348 /365 /435 /444 /445 /447 /448 /465 MODEL 202.028 as of 1.9.95, ...

AR42.10-P-0220A
Remove/install brake disc
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

8.12.11

P42.10-2005-09

Modification notes
29.11.11

Long-life grease repair materials replaced by hot-grease


paste

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of injury to skin and eyes caused by


handling hot or glowing objects.
Notes on repairs to brake system

p
1

Step 5

Wear safety gloves, protective clothing and


safety glasses, if necessary.

AS00.00-Z-0002-01A
AH42.00-P-0003-01A

Remove wheels
Remove/install wheels, rotate if necessary

AP40.10-P-4050Z
i Only if removing brake disks (61) at rear
axle.

Release parking brake

Check brake lining thickness and brake disks i Only replace brake pads and brake disks
(61)
(61) in complete sets if necessary.
Check brake lining thickness
Model 129, 140 as of 1.7.93,
AP42.10-P-4253AM
Model 170, 202, 208, 210
Inspect condition of brake disks
AP42.10-P-4258AM

e
e
4

Remove brake disk

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0220a, Remove/install brake disc


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

p Do not detach brake hose, instead attach


brake caliper to vehicle so that it is free of
tension. Do not kink or tension brake hose,
as otherwise it will be damaged.
At the front axle:
Model 129, 140,
AR42.10-P-0070AM
Model 208.370 /470 up to 18.1.99 except
code 491 USA version,
model 210.070 up to 7.2.99
except code 491 USA version,
except code 498 Japan version,
except code 625 Australia version,
except code 957 AMG engineering package,
model 210.072 /270 /272 up to 7.2.99

33

Page 1 of 3

Model 202.024 /025 /026 /029 /082 /085


/086 /088 /089 /128 /188,
Model 170.435 /444 /445 /447 /449 /465,
Model 208.335 /344 /345 /347 /348 /365
/435 /444 /445 /447 /448/ 465,
Model 210.00 /01 /02 /035 /037 /04 /053 /06
/081 /082 /20 /21 /22 /23 /24 /26 /282 /60 /61
/663,
model 210.083 /283 up to 7.2.99,
model 210.070 /270
with code 491 USA version,
with code 498 Japan version,
with code 625 Australia version,
model 208.370 /470 with code 494 USA
version,
model 202.028 as of 1.9.95, 210.055, except
code 957 AMG engineering package
Model 202.018 /020 /022 /023 /078 /080
/081 /083 /087 /120 /121 /122 /125 /133
/180 /182 /193,
model 202.028 up to 31.8.95 except code
957 AMG engineering package
Model 170.466, 208.374,
model 208.370 /470 as of 19.1.99 except
code 494 USA version,
model 202.033 /093, 210.072 /074 /274 with
code 957 AMG engineering package,
model 210.070 as of 8.2.99,
except code 494 USA version,
except code 498 Japan version,
except code 625 Australia version,
model 210.083 /270 /283 as of 8.2.99
Model 202.028, 210.055 with code 957 AMG
engineering package C 36, E 36
At the rear axle:
Model 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210 except
code 957 AMG engineering package
Model 202.028 /033 /093, 210.055 /072 /074
/274 with code 957 AMG engineering
package
5

Remove locking bolt (64) and remove brake


disk (61)

i Installation: Only replace brake disks


(61) in pairs. Lightly grease seat of brake
disk (61) and replace the safety bolt (64).
Hot lubricating paste

AR42.10-P-0070BM

AR42.10-P-0070CM

AR42.10-P-0070DM

AR42.10-P-0070EM

AR42.10-P-0080AM
AR42.10-P-0080BM

*BR00.45-Z-1005-06A

i Models 129, 140, 202: Ensure that the


dowel pin or roll pins (63) are properly
seated in the brake disk (61).
i Models 202.033 /093, 208.374, 210.072
with code 957 AMG engineering package E
50 AMG 210.074 /274
The left and right brake disks (61) are
different.
Identification:
AMG A210 421 1912 right side
AMG A210 421 1812 left side
i Model 140 up to 3.9.93
When installing new brake disks on front
axle:
Pull out roll pins on front wheel hub.

Fixture for pulling out roll pins on front wheel


hub

AR42.10-P-0220-01A
WF58.50-P-4210-02A

*BA42.10-P-1001-06A
AH42.10-P-9406-04A

Notes on installing brake disks

n
Model 129.067 as of 1.6.1994, 129.076

k
n

Front axle brake disks modified

Model 129.067 as of 1.6.94

BT42.10-P-9406-01A

Front axle brake system, function

Model 210.072 /272 with code 957 AMG


engineering package E 50 AMG

GF42.10-P-0002A

6
7

Install in the reverse order


Adjust parking brake

*BA42.10-P-1002-06A

Model 129, 140 as of 1.11.93, 170, 202, 208, AR42.20-P-0540A


210
Model 140 up to 31.10.93
AR42.20-P-0540B

n Brake discs, brake cover plate


Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0220a, Remove/install brake disc


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Model
129

Model
140

Model
170

34

Page 2 of 3

BA42.10-P-1001-06A

Locking bolt of rear axle brake disk

Nm

10

10

10

BA42.10-P-1002-06A

Locking bolt of front axle brake disk

Nm

10

10

10

Model
202

Model
208

Model
210.0

n Brake discs, brake cover plate


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1001-06A

Locking bolt of rear axle brake disk

Nm

10

10

10

BA42.10-P-1002-06A

Locking bolt of front axle brake disk

Nm

10

10

10

n Brake discs, brake cover plate


Number

Designation

Model
210.2/ 6

BA42.10-P-1001-06A

Locking bolt of rear axle brake disk

Nm

10

BA42.10-P-1002-06A

Locking bolt of front axle brake disk

Nm

10

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1005-06A

Designation
Paste, hot lubrication 1 kg, DB supply specification 6879.20

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0220a, Remove/install brake disc


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Order number
A 000 989 76 51

35

Page 3 of 3

AR42.20-P-0540A
Adjust parking brake
MODEL
129, 170, 202, 203, 208, 210
MODEL
140 as from 1.11.93
MODEL
209.3/ 4

21.6.94

P42.20-0222-04

Modification notes
23.8.05

Clearance adjustment value changed to 8 teeth

Check

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off of the lifting platform.

1.1

Check version of pedal assembly


Parking brake pedal assembly modified

k
2.1

2.2

Operate parking brake pedal and check


pedal travel of parking brake pedal

Step 7

Align vehicle between the columns of the


AS00.00-Z-0010-01A
and position the four support plates below
the lifting platform support points specified by
the vehicle manufacturer.
Except model 170
BT42.20-P-0510-01A
Except model 170

i If the pedal travel is not within the


tolerance range:
Adjusting parking brake.
Actuating force on parking brake pedal
Notches through which the parking brake
pedal must be depressed
Operate parking brake lever and check travel Model 170
of the parking brake lever

*BE42.20-P-1001-01C
*BE42.20-P-1002-01C

i Adjust parking brake, if the parking brake


lever can be pulled up by more than 3
notches without any adequate braking effect
taking place.
e
3
4.1
5

e
6

k
7

8.1
g
9.1

Remove
Raise vehicle at rear
Slacken adjusting screw (89)
Undo a wheel bolt at the left and right rear
wheel

Models 129, 170


p Light alloy wheels must be removed due
to the risk of damage.

Remove/install wheels, rotate if necessary


Adjust
Use screwdriver to rotate adjusting wheel
(105) until the brake shoes abut the parking
brake drum and the rear wheel or brake disk
can no longer be turned by hand.

Adjusting mechanism for parking brake


modified
Turn back adjusting wheel (105) until the
wheel or brake disk is able to rotate
completely freely by hand
Turn in adjusting screw (89) until the brake
cables no longer sag
Check
Operate parking brake pedal several times
and check pedal travel of the parking brake
pedal, then release the parking brake

AP40.10-P-4050Z
i Actuation direction for applying the brake
shoes:
Right side: Turn the adjusting wheel (105)
from the bottom upwards.
Left side: Turn the adjusting wheel (105)
from the top downwards.
Type 140
BT42.20-P-9311-01A
i When loosening the adjusting wheels
(105) ensure
that both sides are turned back by the same
number of teeth (8 teeth).
Model 129, 170

Except model 170

Actuating force on parking brake pedal


Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.20-p-0540a, Adjust parking brake
MODEL 129, 170, 202, 203, 208, 210 MODEL 140 as from 1.11.93 MODEL 209.3/ 4

*BE42.20-P-1001-01C
36

Page 1 of 3

9.2

Operate parking brake lever several times,


check parking brake lever travel, and then
release the parking brake

Notches through which the parking brake


pedal must be depressed
Model 170

*BE42.20-P-1002-01C

i Turn in adjusting screw (89) until the


parking brake lever can be actuated by one
tooth with an average force application of
approx. 90 to 120 Nm.
10
d
11

Check for unobstructed movement of rear


wheels or brake disks
Install
Fit wheel bolts or light alloy wheels
Remove/install wheels, rotate if necessary.

AP40.10-P-4050Z

Adjustment values for parking brake


Number

Designation

BE42.20-P-1001-01C

Actuating force on parking brake pedal

BE42.20-P-1002-01C

Notches through which the parking brake pedal


must be depressed

N
Quantity

See fig.

Model
129, Pedal
assembly with
pulled notch

Model
129, Pedal
assembly with
pushed notch

170 (-50/+70)

170 (-50/+70)

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

Model
140, Pedal
assembly with
pulled notch

Model
140, Pedal
assembly with
pushed notch

170 (-50/+70)

170 (-50/+70)

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

Model
202, Pedal
assembly with
pulled notch

Model
202, Pedal
assembly with
pushed notch

170 (-50/+70)

170 (-50/+70)

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

Adjustment values for parking brake


Number

Designation

BE42.20-P-1001-01C

Actuating force on parking brake pedal

BE42.20-P-1002-01C

Notches through which the parking brake pedal


must be depressed

N
Quantity

See fig.

Adjustment values for parking brake


Number

Designation

BE42.20-P-1001-01C

Actuating force on parking brake pedal

BE42.20-P-1002-01C

Notches through which the parking brake pedal


must be depressed

N
Quantity

See fig.

Adjustment values for parking brake


Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.20-p-0540a, Adjust parking brake
MODEL 129, 170, 202, 203, 208, 210 MODEL 140 as from 1.11.93 MODEL 209.3/ 4

37

Page 2 of 3

Number

Designation

BE42.20-P-1001-01C

Actuating force on parking brake pedal

BE42.20-P-1002-01C

Notches through which the parking brake pedal


must be depressed

N
Quantity

See fig.

Model
203, Pedal
assembly with
pulled notch

Model
203, Pedal
assembly with
pushed notch

170 (-50/+70)

170 (-50/+70)

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

Model
208, Pedal
assembly with
pulled notch

Model
208, Pedal
assembly with
pushed notch

170 (-50/+70)

170 (-50/+70)

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

Model
209, Pedal
assembly with
pulled notch

Model
209, Pedal
assembly with
pushed notch

170 (-50/+70)

170 (-50/+70)

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

Model
210, Pedal
assembly with
pulled notch

Model
210, Pedal
assembly with
pushed notch

170 (-50/+70)

170 (-50/+70)

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

BT42.20-P-0510-01A

Adjustment values for parking brake


Number

Designation

BE42.20-P-1001-01C

Actuating force on parking brake pedal

BE42.20-P-1002-01C

Notches through which the parking brake pedal


must be depressed

N
Quantity

See fig.

Adjustment values for parking brake


Number

Designation

BE42.20-P-1001-01C

Actuating force on parking brake pedal

BE42.20-P-1002-01C

Notches through which the parking brake pedal


must be depressed

N
Quantity

See fig.

Adjustment values for parking brake


Number

Designation

BE42.20-P-1001-01C

Actuating force on parking brake pedal

BE42.20-P-1002-01C

Notches through which the parking brake pedal


must be depressed

N
Quantity

See fig.

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar42.20-p-0540a, Adjust parking brake


MODEL 129, 170, 202, 203, 208, 210 MODEL 140 as from 1.11.93 MODEL 209.3/ 4

38

Page 3 of 3

AR05.20-P-6992AU
Remove/install camshafts
ENGINE 112
ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254
ENGINE 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246
ENGINE 113 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 211, 215, 220, 230

29.1.09

P05.20-0303-09

Shown on engine 112


1
Camshaft Hall sensor
2
Chain tensioner

3
4
5

Right-hand camshaft locating plate 40 after first ignition


TDC
Camshaft bearing bridge
Cable tie

Modification notes
18.6.97

M112: Procedure modified, new special tool.

Step 1-14

*112589010300

Air filter mounted on vehicle


Air filter mounted on engine

AR01.20-P-5014B
AR01.20-P-5014BV
AR05.10-P-6858V

e
1

Removing

Position piston of cylinder 1 at 40 after TDC i Rotate engine at crankshaft in direction


of rotation until 40 marking on belt pulley/
vibration damper is aligned with marking on
timing case cover. The grooves on the
camshafts must be pointing toward the inner
V.

Remove chain tensioner (2)

Remove cylinder head covers

i Engine must not be rotated backwards.


Model 129, 463
Model 163 except 163.174 /175
Model 202, 208, 210 with engine 113
Model 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210 with
engine 112
Model 163.174/ 175
Model 209.375 /475
Model 209.376 /476 up to 23.4.04
Model 203 with engine 113
Model 209.376/ 476 as of 24.4.04
Model 211.0 with engine 112, 113
Model 211.276
Model 215
Model 220, 230 with engine 112, 113
Model 211.2 except 211.276 with engine
112, 113
Model 171 with engine 113

AR05.10-P-7800C

AR05.10-P-7800CA

AR05.10-P-7800AC
AR05.10-P-7800AM

39

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar05.20-p-6992au, Remove/install camshafts


Page 1 of 4
ENGINE 112 ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254 ENGINE 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246 ENGINE ...

Remove camshaft Hall sensor (1)

Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, AR15.10-P-2000A
215, 220 with engine 112
Model 129, 163, 202, 208, 210 with engine
113 except engine 113.990 /991
Model 209 except 209.475
Model 211 except 211.076 /261 /265 /270
/276
Model 463 with engine 113.962
Model 463 with engine 113.982
Model 211.076 / 276
AR15.10-P-2000RVK
Model 215.374, 220.074 /174
Model 203 with engine 113
AR15.10-P-2000AC
Model 171
Model 209.475
Model 211.261 /265 /270

Detach camshaft sprocket, take off

i Tie camshaft sprocket and timing chain


together with cable tie (5).

7
d
8
i

Take off camshaft bearing bridge (4)

l Open-end wrench

*112589000100

l Insertion tool

*112589010300

l Torque wrench

*001589722100

i Observe slackening diagram!


Engine 112, 113 except cylinder shutoff,
code 479.
Engine 113.960 with cylinder shutoff, code
479.

AR05.20-P-7103AU
AR05.20-P-7103AV

Remove camshaft
Install
Install camshaft
Camshaft code number and assignment

i Pay attention to camshaft marking when


installing camshaft.
Engine 112, 113

AH05.20-N-0100-01A

i Oil the bearing surfaces!


Pay attention to correct position of cap on
front end of camshaft.
9

10

11

Install camshaft bearing bridge (4).

i Observe tightening procedure.


Engine 112, 113 except cylinder shutoff,
code 479.
Engine 113.960 with cylinder shutoff, code
479.

Rotate camshaft to basic position

Install camshaft sprocket

Install camshaft Hall sensor (1)

13

Install chain tensioner (2)

AR05.20-P-7103AV

l Locating plate

AR05.20-P-6020AU
*112589003200

l Locating plate

*112589013200

l Open-end wrench

*112589000100

i Take off cable tie (5)!


n

12

AR05.20-P-7103AU

*BA05.20-P-1001-01B

*112589000100
l Open-end wrench
Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, AR15.10-P-2000A
215, 220 with engine 112
Model 129, 163, 202, 208, 210 with engine
113 except engine 113.990 /991
Model 209 except 209.475
Model 211 except 211.076 /261 /265 /270
/276
Model 463 with engine 113.962
Model 463 with engine 113.982
Model 211.076 / 276
AR15.10-P-2000RVK
Model 215.374, 220.074 /174
Model 203 with engine 113
AR15.10-P-2000AC
Model 171
Model 209.475
Model 211.261 /265 /270
*BA15.10-P-1002-03A
n
Model 129, 463
Model 163 except 163.174 /175
Model 202, 208, 210 with engine 113
Model 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210 with
engine 112
Model 163.174/ 175
Model 209.375 /475
Model 209.376 /476 up to 23.4.04
Model 203 with engine 113
Model 209.376/ 476 as of 24.4.04
Model 211.0 with engine112, 113
Model 211.276
Model 215
Model 220, 230 with engine 112, 113

AR05.10-P-7800C

AR05.10-P-7800CA

AR05.10-P-7800AC
AR05.10-P-7800AM

40

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar05.20-p-6992au, Remove/install camshafts


Page 2 of 4
ENGINE 112 ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254 ENGINE 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246 ENGINE ...

Model 211.2 except 211.276 with engine


112, 113
Model 171 with engine 113
14
15

Check engine valve timing


Install cylinder head covers

Air filter mounted on vehicle


Air filter mounted on engine

AR05.10-P-6858V
AR01.20-P-5014B
AR01.20-P-5014BV

n Camshaft
Number

Designation

BA05.20-P-1001-01B

Bolt, camshaft sprocket

M12 45

Engine
112
except
112.951/976

Engine
112.951/
976

Stage 1

Nm

50

50

Stage 2

90

90

n Camshaft
Number

Designation

BA05.20-P-1001-01B

Bolt, camshaft sprocket

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
948/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986/992/995

M12 45

Stage 1

Nm

50

Stage 2

90

n Camshaft
Number

Designation

BA05.20-P-1001-01B

Bolt, camshaft sprocket

M12 45

Engine
113.960
without code
479

Engine
113.960
with code 479

Stage 1

Nm

50

50

Stage 2

90

90

Engine
113.987/988/
990/993

Engine
113.991

n Camshaft
Number

Designation

BA05.20-P-1001-01B

Bolt, camshaft sprocket

M12 45

Stage 1

Nm

50

50

Stage 2

90

90
41

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar05.20-p-6992au, Remove/install camshafts


Page 3 of 4
ENGINE 112 ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254 ENGINE 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246 ENGINE ...

n Position sensor
Number

Designation

BA15.10-P-1002-03A

Camshaft Hall sensor to cylinder head

112 589 00 01 00
Open end wrench

112 589 01 32 00
Locating plate

Nm

Engine
112.910/911/
912/913/914/
915/916/917/
920/921/922/
923/940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/947/
949/951/953/
954/955/960/
961/970/972/
973/975/976

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
948/960/961/
962/963/964/
965/966/967/
968/969/971/
980/981/982/
984/986/992/
993/995

Engine
113.987/
988/990/
991

112 589 00 32 00
Locating plate

112 589 01 03 00
Insertion tool

001 589 72 21 00
Torque wrench

42

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar05.20-p-6992au, Remove/install camshafts


Page 4 of 4
ENGINE 112 ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254 ENGINE 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246 ENGINE ...

AR03.20-P-4351AV
ENGINES 112

Remove/install crankshaft

6.8.10

P03.20-2023-09

1
2
3
4
5

Crankshaft
Crankshaft bearing shell with oil
drilling and oil groove (crankcase)
Crankshaft bearing shell
Crankshaft bearing cap
Fitted bearing

6
7
8
9

Thrust plate
Crankshaft bearing bolts
(M8x75 Torx)
Crankshaft bearing bolts
(M10x90 Torx)
Crankshaft bearing bolts at side
(M8x40 Torx)

10
11
12
13
14
15
16

Crankshaft bearing cap


Connecting rod
Connecting rod bolts
Connecting rod bearing shell
Anti-twist lock
Groove
Connecting rod bearing cap

Modification notes
27.2.04

Figure modified from 30 Nm and 90


and 90

to 5 Nm, 30 Nm

Removing

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off the lifting platform.

2.1

2.2

Figure in BA03.20-P-1003-01D of ENGINE


112, 113 modified

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
Remove engine
Model 463
Model 220 without 4MATIC
Model 220 with 4MATIC
Model 210 with 4MATIC
Model 210 without 4MATIC, 208, 202, 129
Model 211.061/065
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209
Model 203 with 4MATIC
Model 170
Model 163
Remove automatic transmission from engine Model 463
Model 220 without 4MATIC
Model 220 with 4MATIC
Models 210, 208, 202, 170, 129
Model 211.061/065
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209
Model 203 with 4MATIC
Model 163
Remove manual transmission from engine
Model 210, 202, 129
Model 211.061
Model 203, 209
Model 170
Model 208 with transmission 716.6

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar03.20-p-4351av, Remove/install crankshaft


ENGINES 112

*BA03.20-P-1003-01D

AS00.00-Z-0010-01A

AR01.10-P-2400CC
AR01.10-P-2400AB
AR01.10-P-2400IW
AR01.10-P-2400C
AR01.10-P-2400CB
AR01.10-P-2400TC
AR01.10-P-2400PV
AR01.10-P-2400PW
AR01.10-P-2400SV
AR01.10-P-2400CA
AR27.10-P-0500BD
AR27.10-P-0500I
AR27.10-P-0500IW
AR27.10-P-0500B
AR27.10-P-0500T
AR27.10-P-0500P
AR27.10-P-0500PW
AR27.10-P-0500GH
AR26.10-P-0020A
AR26.10-P-0020T
AR26.10-P-0020P
AR26.10-P-0020D
AR26.10-P-0020D
43

Page 1 of 4

Remove oil pan top section

Remove oil pump

Detach belt pulley/vibration damper

6
7
8

Detach flywheel/driven plate


Take off end cover
Take off timing case cover

Remove connecting rod bearing cap (16)

Model 208 with transmission 716.6 (code


424)
Model 463
Model 220 without 4MATIC
Model 220 with 4MATIC
Model 210 with 4MATIC
Model 210 without 4MATIC
Model 211.061/065
Model 208, 202
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209
Model 203 with 4MATIC
Model 170
Model 163
Model 129
i For this step, push back chain tensioner
and take off chain.
Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208.365 /465, 210,
220 without 4MATIC, 463
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209,
211.061/065
Model 203 with 4MATIC, 220 with 4MATIC
Model 129, 463, 163
Model 170, 202, 203, 208.365/465, 209, 210,
211.061/065, 220

Model 463
Model 220, 210 without 4MATIC, 208, 202,
129, 163, 170
Model 210 with 4MATIC
Model 203, 209, 211.061/065

AR26.10-P-0020E
AR01.45-P-7500FG
AR01.45-P-7500I
AR01.45-P-7500IW
AR01.45-P-7500FA
AR01.45-P-7500F
AR01.45-P-7500TV
AR01.45-P-7500FC
AR01.45-P-7500PV
AR01.45-P-7500PW
AR01.45-P-7500SV
AR01.45-P-7500FB
AR01.45-P-7500FD

AR18.10-P-6020B
AR18.10-P-6020PV
AR18.10-P-6020PW
AR03.30-P-1600C
AR03.30-P-1600CA
AR03.30-P-8001C
AR01.40-P-8913B
AR01.40-P-8000GV
AR01.40-P-8000B
AR01.40-P-8000V
AR01.40-P-8000PV

i While turning the crankshaft, ensure that


the connecting rods (11) do not get jammed.
i For this step, mark connecting rod (11)
and connecting rod bearing cap (16) on one
side relative to each other.

10

Unscrew crankshaft bearing cap bolts

i Pay attention to the bolt release pattern:


Bolt tightening procedure for crankshaft
bearing cap(s)

11

Remove the crankshaft bearing caps (4, 10)


and fitted bearing (5)

12
13

Take crankshaft (1) out of crankcase


Take crankshaft bearing shells (2) and thrust
washers (6) out of the crankcase
Install

d
14

15

Insert crankshaft (1)

Tighten crankshaft bearing caps

16.1
17

Check axial play of crankshaft


Check connecting rod bolts (12)

18

Install connecting rod bearings and fit the


connecting rod bearing cap (16)

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar03.20-p-4351av, Remove/install crankshaft


ENGINES 112

AR03.20-P-4351-02AV

i Before removing, mark crankshaft bearing


caps (4, 10) and fitted bearing (5).
Carefully lever out crankshaft bearing caps
(10) and (5).

i Oil crankshaft journals and crankshaft


bearing shells (2)
If a new crankshaft is being installed
If crankshaft is being repaired

AR03.20-P-4341-01CV
AR03.20-P-4341-01CVA

p Always fit new crankshaft bearing cap


bolts M8X75 and M10X90, otherwise there is
a risk of cracks and fracture. Tighten all bolts
(M10, M8) at the same time, as specified in
the tightening diagram.
Tightening procedure
AR03.20-P-4351-02AV
*BA03.20-P-1001-01D
n Bolt (7)
n Side bolt (9)

*BA03.20-P-1002-01D

n Bolt (8)
If a new crankshaft is being installed

*BA03.20-P-1003-01D

o Check values:
Thread and shank length

AR03.20-P-4291-03AV
AR03.10-P-6111-01BV

*BE03.10-P-1001-03A
AR03.10-P-6111-06AV
p The connecting rod bearing shell (13)
with oil drilling (arrowed) must be mounted in
the connecting rod (11), otherwise the
connecting rod bearings will not be
lubricated.
The anti-twist locks (14) of the connecting
rod bearing shells (13) must be located in the
grooves (15) in the connecting rod (11) and
the connecting rod bearing cap (16).
44

Page 2 of 4

p The connecting rod (11) and connecting


rod bearing cap (16) are cracked (broken)
(see zoomed section). They must not be
installed on the wrong side, as dimensional
accuracy would be lost.
19

Tighten connecting rod bolts (12)


n

AR03.10-P-6111-02BV
*BA03.10-P-1001-01E

20

Rotate crankshaft

i To check for unobstructed movement.

21

Fit on end cover

22
23

Mount flywheel/drive plate


Mount timing case cover

AR01.40-P-8913B
i Fit a new radial sealing ring.
The sealing lip of radial sealing ring and its
mating surface must not be oiled or greased.
Pay attention to the fitted sleeves when
pressing on the end cover.
AR03.30-P-8001C

24

Mount belt pulley/vibration damper

25

Mount oil pump

26

Fit oil pan top section

27
28.1

Check engine valve timing


Fit automatic transmission

28.2

Fit on manual transmission

29

Install engine

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar03.20-p-4351av, Remove/install crankshaft


ENGINES 112

i Replace the O-rings and radial sealing


ring.
The sealing lip of radial sealing ring and its
mating surface must not be oiled or greased.
Pay attention to fitted sleeves when pressing
on end cover!
Model 463
Model 220, 210 without 4MATIC, 208, 202,
129, 163, 170
Model 210 with 4MATIC
Model 203, 209, 211.061/065
Model 129, 463, 163
Model 170, 202, 203, 208.365/465, 209, 210,
211.061/065, 220
p Ensure that the oil return shutoff valve is
correctly located.
Clean oil pump strainer.
Fill oil pump with engine oil before installing,
so that oil is delivered at the initial startup.
Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208.365 /465, 210,
220 without 4MATIC, 463
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209,
211.061/065
Model 203 with 4MATIC, 220 with 4MATIC
Model 463
Model 220 without 4MATIC
Model 220 with 4MATIC
Model 210 with 4MATIC
Model 210 without 4MATIC
Model 211.061/065
Model 208, 202
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209
Model 203 with 4MATIC
Model 170
Model 163
Model 129
Model 463
Model 220 without 4MATIC
Model 220 with 4MATIC
Models 210, 208, 202, 170, 129
Model 211.061/065
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209
Model 203 with 4MATIC
Model 163
Model 129, 210, 202
Model 211.061
Model 203, 209
Model 170
Model 208 with transmission 716.6
Model 208 with transmission 716.6 (code
424)
Model 463
Model 220 without 4MATIC
Model 220 with 4MATIC
Model 210 with 4MATIC
Model 210 without 4MATIC, 208, 202, 129.
Model 211.061/065
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209
Model 203 with 4MATIC

AR01.40-P-8000GV
AR01.40-P-8000B
AR01.40-P-8000V
AR01.40-P-8000PV
AR03.30-P-1600C
AR03.30-P-1600CA

AR18.10-P-6020B
AR18.10-P-6020PV
AR18.10-P-6020PW
AR01.45-P-7500FG
AR01.45-P-7500I
AR01.45-P-7500IW
AR01.45-P-7500FA
AR01.45-P-7500F
AR01.45-P-7500TV
AR01.45-P-7500FC
AR01.45-P-7500PV
AR01.45-P-7500PW
AR01.45-P-7500SV
AR01.45-P-7500FB
AR01.45-P-7500FD
AR05.10-P-6858V
AR27.10-P-0500BD
AR27.10-P-0500I
AR27.10-P-0500IW
AR27.10-P-0500B
AR27.10-P-0500T
AR27.10-P-0500P
AR27.10-P-0500PW
AR27.10-P-0500GH
AR26.10-P-0020A
AR26.10-P-0020T
AR26.10-P-0020P
AR26.10-P-0020D
AR26.10-P-0020D
AR26.10-P-0020E
AR01.10-P-2400CC
AR01.10-P-2400AB
AR01.10-P-2400IW
AR01.10-P-2400C
AR01.10-P-2400CB
AR01.10-P-2400TC
AR01.10-P-2400PV
AR01.10-P-2400PW

45

Page 3 of 4

Model 170
Model 163

AR01.10-P-2400SV
AR01.10-P-2400CA

Test specifications for connecting rod bolts


Number

Designation

BE03.10-P-1001-03A

Connecting rod bolts

Engine 112
except
112.951/976,
Engine
113.94/96/971/
980/981/982/
984/986

Thread dia.

Shank length

8 1

New

mm

47

max.

mm

47.6

n Connecting rod
Number

Designation

BA03.10-P-1001-01E

Connecting rod bolt

Engines
112, 113

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Nm

25

Stage 3

90

n Crankshaft bearing cap


Number

Designation

BA03.20-P-1001-01D

Bolt for crankshaft bearing


cap

BA03.20-P-1002-01D

BA03.20-P-1003-01D

Side crankshaft bearing cap


bolt

Bolt for crankshaft bearing


cap

Daimler AG, 8/1/15, G/04/14, ar03.20-p-4351av, Remove/install crankshaft


ENGINES 112

Engines
112, 113

M8

Stage 1

Nm

20

Stage 2

90

Stage 1

Nm

30

Stage 2

M10 Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Nm

30

Stage 3

90

M8

46

Page 4 of 4

AR20.20-P-3865HD
Remove/install radiator
ENGINE
112 in MODEL 210, 208, 202
ENGINE
113 in MODEL 210, 208, 202

2.2.09

P20.20-2006-09

Shown on model 210 with M112 without 4-Matic


1
2
3
4
5
6, 7
8

Viscous fan
Fan shroud
Air inlet pipe of air filter
Protective grille
Bracket of ATF line
ATF line
Radiator

ed
1
a Danger!

Remove engine panel


Risk of injury to skin and eyes caused by
scalding from contact with hot coolant spray.
Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
coolant.

Drain coolant at radiator, pour in


Remove viscous fan (1)

Remove fan shroud (2).

5.1

Remove protective grille (4)

6.1

Unscrew bracket (5) of ATF line (6) from


lower radiator (8)
Detach ATF lines (6, 7) at radiator

8.1

Clamp fan shroud


Radiator crossmember
Coolant line (radiator
thermostat housing)
Coolant line (radiator
coolant pump)
Coolant line (expansion tank
radiator)
Coolant line (expansion tank
radiator)
Clamp radiator

Remove/install

2
3.1

9
10
11
12
13
14
15

Remove air inlet pipe (3) of air filter

AR61.20-P-1105AB
Do not open cooling system unless coolant
AS20.00-Z-0001-01A
temperature is below 90C. Open cap slowly
and release the pressure. Do not pour
coolant into beverage containers.
Wear protective gloves, protective clothing
and safety glasses.
AR20.00-P-1142HA
All except models 208.365/465
AR20.40-P-5660C
i Right-hand thread!
- On vehicles with suction fan, first
disconnect connector for suction fan.
Only on model 208 with engine 113 and on
model 210, 202
All except model 210 with model 113
i
Model 210 with engine 113:
Disconnect ATF lines (6, 7) from rubber
hoses and plug in connections.
l

*129589009100

*BA20.20-P-1003-01A

n
Only on model 210 with engine 112, 113
Model 208 with engine 113

*BA20.20-P-1001-01A

i
On model 208 with engine 113 both air inlet
pipes must be removed.
9
10.1

Remove clamps (15)


Remove radiator crossmember (10)

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.20-p-3865hd, Remove/install radiator


ENGINE 112 in MODEL 210, 208, 202 ENGINE 113 in MODEL 210, 208, 202

All except model 210 with 4-MATIC

47

Page 1 of 2

11
12.1

Unplug coolant line (11, 12, 13) at radiator


Unplug coolant line (14) at radiator (8)

13
14

Unscrew capacitor at radiator (see arrows)


Remove radiator (8)

15
16

Install in the reverse order


Pour in coolant
Risk of accident caused by vehicle starting
off by itself when engine is running. Risk of
injury caused by contusions and burns
during starting procedure or when working
near the engine as it is running
Check oil level in automatic transmission,
correct if necessary
Inspect cooling system for leaks

a Danger!

17
18

Only on model 210 with engine 112, 113


Model 208 with engine 113
i
On model 208 the coolant line (14) is
mounted on upper left radiator.
Installation:
The studs on the radiator must be located at
the bottom in the rubber mounts on the
crossmember.

Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving by


itself.
Wear closed and snug-fitting work clothes.
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.

AR20.00-P-1142HA
AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

AR27.00-P-0100AC
AR20.00-P-1010HA

n Radiator, coolant hoses


Number

Designation

BA20.20-P-1001-01A

Union nut, automatic transmission oil


line to radiator

BA20.20-P-1003-01A

Banjo bolt

M12 1.5

Engine
112 except
112.942/970,
engine
113.940/941/
943/944/945/
946/948/960/
961/962/963/
966/967/968/
969/980/982/
984/986/992/
993/995

Engine
112.942/
970,
113.942/
965/981

Nm

20

20

Nm

30

30

129 589 00 91 00
Set of stop plugs

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.20-p-3865hd, Remove/install radiator


ENGINE 112 in MODEL 210, 208, 202 ENGINE 113 in MODEL 210, 208, 202

48

Page 2 of 2

AR13.22-P-1202BA
Remove, install poly V-belt
ENGINE 112 in MODEL 202, 208.365 /465, 210, 220.063 /065 /067 /087 /163 /165 /167 /187
ENGINE 113 in MODEL 215.373 /375, 220.070 /073 /075 /083 /084 /170 /173 /175 /183 /184 /875
ENGINE 113.981 in MODEL 163.174
ENGINE 113.965 in MODEL 163.175
ENGINE 113.984 in MODEL 208.374 /474

12.4.06

Shown on engine 112


1
2
3
4
5

Electric fan
Fan shroud
Poly-V-belt
Stud bolt
Tensioning pulley

P13.22-2030-06

e
1.1
2

Remove

g
3

Check

Remove fan shroud (2) with electric fan (1)


Loosen and remove the poly-V-belt (3)

Inspect belt pulley sections and tensioning


device for damage and dirt
Check poly-V-belt (3)
Check poly-V-belt in visible area for wear

e
d
5

Install

6.1

Install fan shroud (2) with electric fan

Fit on poly-V-belt (3), then clamp

For models 163.174/175 only.

AR20.40-P-5000GH

i For this step, swivel stud bolt (4) at


tensioning pulley (5) in anti-clockwise
direction Lock the tension pulley with a pin
or mandrel (diameter 5mm).
l External torx set

*001589760900

Engine 112, 113 except 113.965/981

AP13.22-P-1352Z

Engine 113.981/965 in model 163

AP13.22-P-1351GH

i Do not use belt wax or any similar


products.
Proceed by the numbered sequence of the
respective belt routing pattern, starting with
the tension pulley:
Routing diagram of poly V-belt
For models 163.174/175 only.

AR13.22-P-3902-02B
AR20.40-P-5000GH

001 589 76 09 00
External Torx set

49

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar13.22-p-1202ba, Remove, install poly V-belt


Page 1 of 1
ENGINE 112 in MODEL 202, 208.365 /465, 210, 220.063 /065 /067 /087 /163 /165 /167 /187 ENGINE 113 in MODEL 215.373 /375, 220.070 /073 /075 /083 /084 /170 /173 /175 /183 /184 /875 ...

AR01.20-P-5014B
Remove/install cylinder head cover
ENGINES 112
Air filter positioned at vehicle side
ENGINES 113
Air filter positioned at vehicle side

24.6.10

Shown on engine 112


1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10

Air cleaner housing


Resonance unit
Resonance tube
Right cylinder head cover
Left cylinder head cover
Right ignition coils
Left ignition coils
Right connection
Left connection
Left connection

P01.20-0221-06

ed

Remove/install

i
1
2
3
4

l External torx set

*001589760900

l Torx bit set

*000589011000

Remove engine trim panel


Remove air filter housing (1).
Remove resonance body (2)
Remove the resonance tube (3) with hot film i
mass air flow sensor
At this time pull out the hot film mass air
flow sensor plug.
p Removal:
Pay attention to the mounting projection of
the resonance tube (3)!
All except model 163 with engine
113.942/981
Model 163 with engine 113.942/981

5
6

Unbolt dipstick guide tube of


automatic transmission
Unbolt ignition coils (6, 7) at cylinder head
covers
Disconnect spark plug connectors

Detach the vacuum hoses at connections (8,


9) of the cylinder head covers
Detach crankcase ventilation hose at
cylinder head cover fitting (10)
Risk of explosion caused by ignition of
flammable products, risk of poisoning
caused by inhaling fuel vapors or swallowing
fuel as well as risk of injury to skin and
eyes exposed to fuel.
Disconnect fuel line at fuel rail

a Danger!

10

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar01.20-p-5014b, Remove/install cylinder head cover


ENGINES 112 Air filter positioned at vehicle side ENGINES 113 Air filter positioned at vehicle side

*BA01.20-P-1002-01E

i
Pay attention to markings for spark plug
connectors on cylinder head covers and
ignition coils
l

AR07.07-P-1454MV

AR15.12-P-2003A
n

AR07.07-P-1454A

*110589010100

i Only on left side.


No fire, sparks, open flames or smoking.
AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
i
Only in case of vehicles with a non-flexible
fuel line.
Release fuel pressure through service valve!
50

Page 1 of 3

11

12
a Danger!

13

Remove cylinder head covers (4, 5)

Install in the reverse order


Risk of accident caused by vehicle starting
off by itself when engine is running. Risk of
injury caused by contusions and burns
during starting procedure or when working
near the engine as it is running
Check for leaks with engine running

l Pressure hose

*119589046300

*BA07.52-P-1001-01A

*BA07.52-P-1001-01A

*BA01.20-P-1001-01E

i Installation:
Ensure cylinder head cover gasket is
correctly installed.

AR01.20-P-5014-01B

Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving by


itself.
Wear closed and snug-fitting work clothes.
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.

AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

n Crankcase ventilation, cylinder head cover


Number

Designation

BA01.20-P-1001-01E

Cylinder head cover bolt

BA01.20-P-1002-01E

Engine
112

Engine
113

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Nm

Bolt, ignition coils to cylinder


head cover

n Fuel distributor
Number

Designation

BA07.52-P-1001-01A

Fuel feed line to fuel distributor

Nm

Engine
112 except
112.945/951/
960/961

Engine
112.945

Engine
112.951/
976

Engine
112.960/
961 AMG

38

38

24

35

Engine
113.987

Engine
113.990/
991

Engine
113.992/
993/995

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986/988

38

38

38

38

n Fuel distributor
Number

Designation

BA07.52-P-1001-01A

Fuel feed line to fuel distributor

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar01.20-p-5014b, Remove/install cylinder head cover


ENGINES 112 Air filter positioned at vehicle side ENGINES 113 Air filter positioned at vehicle side

Nm

51

Page 2 of 3

001 589 76 09 00
External Torx set

000 589 01 10 00
Torx bit set

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar01.20-p-5014b, Remove/install cylinder head cover


ENGINES 112 Air filter positioned at vehicle side ENGINES 113 Air filter positioned at vehicle side

110 589 01 01 00
Open-end wrench, double

119 589 04 63 00
Pressure hose

52

Page 3 of 3

AR03.30-P-1600CA
Remove/install belt pulley/vibration damper
ENGINES 112.947 in MODEL 170
ENGINES 112 in MODELS 202, 208, 209, 210, 220
ENGINES 113 in MODEL 209
ENGINES 113 (except 113.991) in MODEL 215, 220
ENGINES 112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINES 112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINES 113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINES 113.981 in MODEL 163.174
ENGINES 113.963 in MODEL 230.475
ENGINES 112.973 in MODEL 230.467
ENGINES 112.917 in MODELS 211.080 /280
ENGINES 112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINES 113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283
ENGINES 113.988 in MODEL 203.076 /276
ENGINES 113.989 in MODEL 171.473
1
2
3
4

15.11.11

Belt pulley/vibration damper


Center bolt
Poly-V belt
Counterholder

P03.30-2109-06

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off of the lifting platform.

Remove engine compartment paneling

2.1

Remove front engine cover

2.2

Remove air filter housing

3.1

Remove electric fan

3.2

Remove fan shroud

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
Model 163
Model 171
Model 211.061 /065 /070 /080 /082 /083
/261 /265 /270 /280 /282 /283
Model 163.174 with engine 113.981
Model 170 with engine 112.947
Model 202, 208, 209, 210, 220 with engine
112
Model 209 with engine 113 except engine
113.987 from 24.04.04
Model 215, 220 with engine 113
Model 230.467 with engine 112.973
Model 230.475 with engine 113.963
Model 171.473 with engine 113.989
Model 203.076 /276 with engine 113.988
Model 209.376 /476 with engine 113.987 as
of 24.04.04
Model 163
Model 170.465
Model 209 with engine 113
Model 171.473
Model 211.070 /270 /083 /283
Model 202, 208

AS00.00-Z-0010-01A

AR61.20-P-1105GH
AR61.20-P-1105V

AR09.10-P-1150AC

AR20.40-P-5000GH
AR20.40-P-5000SV
AR20.40-P-5000PV
AR20.40-P-6800VT
AR20.40-P-6800TB
53

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar03.30-p-1600ca, Remove/install belt pulley/vibration damper


Page 1 of 2
ENGINES 112.947 in MODEL 170 ENGINES 112 in MODELS 202, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113 in MODEL 209 ENGINES 113 (except 113.991) in MODEL 215, 220 ENGINES 112.913 in ...

Remove poly-V belt (3)

Models 163.174, 202, 208, 210, 215, 220


Model 170.465
Model 171.473
Model 203.076 /276
Model 209.361/ 365/ 375/ 376/ 461/ 465/
475/ 476
Model 211.061 /065 /070 /080 /082 /083
/261 /265 /270 /280 /282 /283
Model 230.467/ 475

Remove center bolt (2)

i Installation: The center bolt (2) should


always be replaced.

AR13.22-P-1202BA
AR13.22-P-1202SV
AR13.22-P-1202PV

AR13.22-P-1202R

i Installation: To set the rotation angle,


make two guide marks on the counterholder
(4).
i Use extension.

Detach belt pulley/vibration damper (1) from


crankshaft

g
7

Checking

10
11
a Danger!

12

*BA03.30-P-1001-01D

*112589004000

i Installation: The groove on belt pulley/


vibration damper (1) must engage in feather
key of the crankshaft.

Check belt pulley/vibration damper (1) for


faults
Check tread on crankshaft radial sealing ring i Check for scoring and galling, if
at hub of belt pulley/vibration damper (1)
necessary, replace belt pulley/vibration
damper (1).
Replace front crankshaft radial sealing ring
i Only when replacing belt pulley/vibration
damper (1) or in the event of a leak at
crankshaft radial sealing ring.
Except model 230.467
Model 230.467
Install in the reverse order
Check engine oil level and replenish oil if
necessary
Risk of accident caused by vehicle starting Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving by
off by itself when engine is running. Risk of itself.
injury caused by contusions and burns
Wear closed and snug-fitting work clothes.
during starting procedure or when working
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.
near the engine as it is running
Conduct engine test run and check engine
for leaks

AR03.20-P-3000BA
AR03.20-P-3000R

AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

n Flywheel, driven plate, vibration damper, starter ring gear


Number

Designation

BA03.30-P-1001-01D

Central bolt on vibration damper

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Engine
112

Engine
113.94/96/
97/98

200

200

90

90

112 589 00 40 00
Counterholder

54

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar03.30-p-1600ca, Remove/install belt pulley/vibration damper


Page 2 of 2
ENGINES 112.947 in MODEL 170 ENGINES 112 in MODELS 202, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113 in MODEL 209 ENGINES 113 (except 113.991) in MODEL 215, 220 ENGINES 112.913 in ...

AR03.30-P-8001C
Remove/install flywheel / drive plate
ENGINE
112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
ENGINE
112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220
ENGINE
113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254
ENGINE
113 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 208, 209, 210, 211.076 /276, 215, 220, 230.474 /475
ENGINE
137 in MODEL 215, 220
ENGINE
112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINE
112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINE
113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINE
113.987 in MODEL 209.376
ENGINE
113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246
ENGINE
112.917 in MODEL 211.080 /280
ENGINE
112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINE
113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283

5.7.11

Shown on engine 112 with manual


transmission
1
2
3
4
5
6

Flywheel with starter ring gear


Washer
Bolts
Cylinder pin
Crankshaft
Retaining lock

P03.30-0283-06

Modification notes
5.7.11

Value modified: Bolt, pressure plate to flywheel or twomass flywheel

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off the lifting platform.

1.1

Remove automatic transmission

1.2

Remove manual transmission

*BA25.10-P-1001-01A

Align vehicle between columns of lifting


platform and position the four support plates
at lifting platform support points specified by
vehicle manufacturer.
Model 129, 170, 202, 208, 210
Model 463
Model 463
Model 230.474 /475
Model 215, 220 without 4MATIC with engine
112, 113
Model 220, 211 with 4MATIC with engine
112, 113
Model 215, 220 with engine 137
Model 203 without 4MATIC, 209 with engine
112, 113
Model 203 with 4MATIC
Model 211 without 4MATIC with engine 112,
113
Model 163 with engine 112, 113
Model 210, 202, 129 with engine 112
Model 203, 209 with engine 112
Model 211 with engine 112
Model 170

AS00.00-Z-0010-01A

AR27.10-P-0500B
AR27.10-P-0500BD
AR27.10-P-0500GA
AR27.10-P-0500R
AR27.10-P-0500I
AR27.10-P-0500IW
AR27.10-P-0500I
AR27.10-P-0500P
AR27.10-P-0500PW
AR27.10-P-0500T
AR27.10-P-0500GH
AR26.10-P-0020A
AR26.10-P-0020P
AR26.10-P-0020T
AR26.10-P-0020D
55

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar03.30-p-8001c, Remove/install flywheel / drive plate


Page 1 of 3
ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 ...

1.3

Remove Sequentronic automated manual


transmission (AMT)

Install retaining lock (6) for crankshaft (5)


and starter ring gear
Detach clutch

3.1

Model 203, 208, 209.3 with engine 112

AR26.10-P-0020E

Model 211.0 with engine 112

AR26.10-P-0020TA
AR03.30-P-5000B

Vehicles with manual transmission


i Only unscrew or screw in bolts by 1 to
1.5 turns at a time
Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 210
Model 203, 209, 211
n Bolt, pressure plate to flywheel or twomass flywheel

Remove bolts (3) of flywheel or of drive


plate

p Installation: Replace bolts, because if


they are used again, the connection may
loosen and the bolts may shear off.
n Torx bolts of two-mass flywheel/driven
plate at crankshaft

5
6

Remove washer (2)


Remove flywheel with starter ring gear (1)
and drive plate

Flywheel, two-mass flywheel, drive plate,


location
Install in the reverse order
Carry out initialization

7
8

AR25.10-P-0050A
AR25.10-P-0050P
*BA25.10-P-1001-01A

i Installation: The cylinder pin (4)


determines the installation position.
Engine 112, 113

*BA03.30-P-1002-01D

GF03.30-P-8001-01B

i If a new flywheel or drive plate is


installed, perform initialization in ME control
unit with STAR DIAGNOSIS in menu item
"Control unit adaptation".
STAR DIAGNOSIS diagnosis system

n Flywheel, driven plate, vibration damper, starter ring gear


Number

Designation

BA03.30-P-1002-01D

Bolt, two-mass flywheel/drive plate to


crankshaft

Engine
112

Stage 1

Nm

45

Stage 2

90

n Flywheel, driven plate, vibration damper, starter ring gear


Number

Designation

BA03.30-P-1002-01D

Bolt, two-mass flywheel/drive plate to


crankshaft

Engine
113.94/96/
97/98

Engine
113.990/
991/992/
993/995

Engine
137

Stage 1

Nm

45

45

45

Stage 2

90

90

90

Model
129, 140,
163, 170,
202, 203,
208, 209,
210, 211,
230

Model
461, 463

n Clutch
Number

Designation

56

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar03.30-p-8001c, Remove/install flywheel / drive plate


Page 2 of 3
ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 ...

BA25.10-P-1001-01A

Bolt of pressure plate to flywheel


or two-mass flywheel

Stage 1

Nm

16

16

Stage 2

Nm

25

25

57

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar03.30-p-8001c, Remove/install flywheel / drive plate


Page 3 of 3
ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 ...

AR07.03-P-6520A
Remove/install injection valves (ME-SFI)
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.089 /029
ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.081 /281 /063 /263
ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163
ENGINE 112.923 in MODEL 129.059
ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINE 112.941 in MODEL 210.282 /065 /082 /265
ENGINE 112.942 in MODEL 163.154
ENGINE 112.943 in MODEL 129.064
ENGINE 112.944 in MODEL 220.165 /065
ENGINE 113.940 in MODEL 210.070 /270
ENGINE 113.941 in MODEL 220.070 /170
ENGINE 113.960 in MODEL 215.375, 220.075 /175
ENGINE 113.961 in MODEL 129.068
ENGINE 112.945, 113.962 /982 in MODEL 463
ENGINE 113.980 in MODEL 210.074 /274
ENGINE 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINE 113.942 in MODEL 163.172
ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINE 113.984 in MODEL 208.374
ENGINE 113.981 in MODEL 163.174
ENGINE 112.912 in MODEL 203.061 /261, 209.361 /461
ENGINE 112.946 in MODEL 203.064 /264
ENGINE 112.947 in MODEL 170.465
ENGINE 112.960 in MODEL 170.466
ENGINE 112.961 in MODEL 203.065 /265
ENGINE 113.963 in MODEL 230.475
ENGINE 113.968 in MODEL 209.375 /475
ENGINE 112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINE 112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINE 113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINE 113.992 in MODEL 230.474
ENGINE 113.987 in MODEL 209.376 /476
ENGINE 112.955 in MODEL 209.365 /465
ENGINE 112.916 in MODEL 203.081 /281
ENGINE 112.953 in MODEL 203.084 /284
ENGINE 112.970 in MODEL 163.157
ENGINE 113.965 in MODEL 163.175
ENGINE 113.990 in MODEL 211.076 /276
ENGINE 113.991 in MODEL 215.374, 220.074 /174
ENGINE 112.973 in MODEL 230.467
ENGINE 112.972 in MODEL 220.067 /167
ENGINE 112.975 in MODEL 220.087 /187
ENGINE 113.948 in MODEL 220.083 /183
ENGINE 113.966 in MODEL 220.084 /184
ENGINE 112.917 in MODEL 211.080 /280
ENGINE 112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINE 113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283
ENGINE 113.988 in MODEL 203.076 /276
ENGINE 113.989 in MODEL 171.473
ENGINE 113.995 in MODEL 230.472

4.12.06

58

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar07.03-p-6520a, Remove/install injection valves (ME-SFI)


Page 1 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.089 /029 ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.081 /281 /063 /263 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ENGINE ...

Shown on engine 112


16/7
17

Anti-twist lock
Fuel distributor

Y62

Fuel injection valves

Arrow:

Square catch

P07.40-0218-12

ed
1

Remove/install
Remove fuel distributor (17) together with
the fuel injectors (Y62)

Model 129.059/ 064/ 068


Model 163.154/ 157 / 172/ 174/ 175
Model 202.026/ 029/ 033/ 086/ 089/ 093
Model 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470
Model 210.063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082
/263 /265 /270 /274 /281 /282
Model 170.465 /466
Model 171.473
Model 203.061 /261 /064 /065 /076 /081
/084 /264 /265 /276 /281 /284
Model 209
Model 211.061 / 065 / 070 / 076 / 080 / 082
/ 083 / 261 / 265 / 270 / 276 / 280 / 282 /
283
Model 215.374/ 375
Model 220.063 /065 /067 /070 /074 /075
/083 /084 /087 /163 /165 /167 /170 /174
/175 /183 /184 /187
Model 230
Engine 112.945, 113.962 in model 463
Engine 113.982 in model 463.241 /243 /246

AR07.03-P-1451A

AR07.03-P-1451AA

AR07.03-P-1451AG

p Check O-rings for damage otherwise this


can lead to leakage. Before installing fuel
injection valves (Y62) lubricate O-rings.
i Anti-twist locks (16/7) must latch into the
square catch (arrow) of the fuel injection
valves (Y62).
2

Install in the reverse order

59

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar07.03-p-6520a, Remove/install injection valves (ME-SFI)


Page 2 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.089 /029 ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.081 /281 /063 /263 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ENGINE ...

AR09.20-P-1310A
Remove/install intake manifold
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089
ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281
ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163
ENGINES 112.923 in MODEL 129.059
ENGINES 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINES 112.941 in MODEL 210.065 /082 /265 /282
ENGINES 112.942 in MODEL 163.154
ENGINES 112.943 in MODEL 129.064
ENGINES 112.944 in MODEL 220.065 /165
ENGINES 113.940 in MODEL 210.070 /270
ENGINES 113.941 in MODEL 220.070 /170
ENGINES 113.960 in MODEL 215.375, 220.075 /175
ENGINES 113.961 in MODEL 129.068
ENGINES 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINES 113.942 in MODEL 163.172
ENGINES 113.980 in MODEL 210.074 /274
ENGINES 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINES 113.984 in MODEL 208.374
ENGINES 113.981 in MODEL 163.174
ENGINES 112.912 in MODEL 203.061 /261, 209.361 /461
ENGINES 112.946 in MODEL 203.064 /264
ENGINES 112.947 in MODEL 170.465
ENGINES 113.963 in MODEL 230.475
ENGINES 113.968 in MODEL 209.375 /475
ENGINES 112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINES 112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINES 113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINES 113.987 in MODEL 209.376 /476
ENGINES 112.955 in MODEL 209.365 /465
ENGINES 112.916 in MODEL 203.081 /281
ENGINES 112.953 in MODEL 203.084 /284
ENGINES 112.970 in MODEL 163.157
ENGINES 112.972 in MODEL 220.067 /167
ENGINES 112.973 in MODEL 230.467
ENGINES 113.965 in MODEL 163.175
ENGINES 112.975 in MODEL 220.087 /187
ENGINES 113.948 in MODEL 220.083 /183
ENGINES 113.966 in MODEL 220.084 /184
ENGINES 112.917 in MODELS 211.080 /280
ENGINES 112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINES 113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283
ENGINES 113.988 in MODEL 203.076 /276
ENGINES 113.989 in MODEL 171.473

24.6.10

Shown on engine 112


2/1
6
17/2
19
19/1
19/3
89
89/2
Arrow

Cylinder head cover bolt


Combination valve
Feed line
Intake manifold
Bolt
Gasket
Exhaust gas recirculation valve
Cable
Hole for combination valve

60

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar09.20-p-1310a, Remove/install intake manifold


Page 1 of 4
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ...

P09.20-0283-06

2
89/2

Crankcase ventilation hose


Cable

P09.20-2137-01

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of explosion caused by fuel igniting,


risk of poisoning caused by inhaling and
swallowing fuel and risk of injury to eyes
and skin caused by contact with fuel
Remove key from electronic ignition switch

2
3.1

Remove cover on front side of engine


Remove engine cover with integrated air
filter

3.2

Remove air filter housing

Remove hot film mass air flow sensor with


air intake pipe

Disconnect lead line (17/2) at the fuel


distributor

No fire, sparks, open flames or smoking.


AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Only pour fuels into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
Only on vehicles with electronic ignition
switch
i Vehicles with Keyless Go code 889:
Switch off engine, remove Keyless Go-Cards
out of vehicle and store outside of the
sender range.
Model 129, 211, 215, 220, 230 only
Except model 171.473, 203.076 /276,
209.376 /476 from 24.4.04
i The air filter is integrated in the engine
cover. Remove engine cover or air filter by
pulling it vertically up and off the cylinder
head covers.
Model 171.473
Model 203.076 /276
Model 209.376/ 476 as of 24.4.04
Engine 112.910 /920 /921 /940 /941 /942
/970
Engine 113.940
Engine 112.922 /944 /972 /973 /975
Engine 113.941 /948 /960 /961 /963 /966
Engine 112.912 /913 /916 /917 /946 /947
/949 /954 /953 /955
Engine 113.968 /967 /969 /987 /988 /989
Engine 112.923/ 943
Engine 113.943 /944 /980 /984
ENGINE 113.942/ 965/ 981

7.1
7.2

Removing fuel rail with injection valves

Remove bolt of cylinder head cover (2/1)

l
Engine 112.910 /920 /921 /923 /940 /941
/942 /943 /970
Engine 113.940 /942 /943 /944 /961 /965
/980 /981 /984
Engine 112.912 /913 /916 /917 /922 /944
/946 /947 /949 /953 /954 /955 /972 /973
/975
Engine 113.941 /948 /960 /963 /966 /967
/968 /969 /987 /988 /989
Model 230.475 only

n
Remove crankshaft ventilation hose (2) and Model 171.473 only
line (89/2) and place to one side
i Remove cylinder head cover (2/1) bolt in
order to detach exhaust gas recirculation
valve (89) bracket.
Disconnect vacuum lines from intake pipe
(19)

AR07.07-P-1454A

AR07.07-P-1454AA
AR07.07-P-1454SV

AR07.07-P-1454AG
AR07.07-P-1454MV

i Release fuel pressure via service valve


and collect fuel!
n

AR09.10-P-1150AC

*BA07.52-P-1001-01A
*119589046300
AR07.03-P-1451A

AR07.03-P-1451AA

*BA01.20-P-1001-01E

*BA01.20-P-1001-01E

i Installation: Observe intake manifold


connection diagram.
Engine 112 except 112.913 /917 /949 /954
Engine 112.913 /917 /949 /954

AR09.20-P-1310-01A
AR09.20-P-1310-01T
61

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar09.20-p-1310a, Remove/install intake manifold


Page 2 of 4
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ...

Engine 112 with USA version, code 494,


except engine 112.913 /916 /917 /949 /953
/954 /975
Engine 112.913 /916 /917 /949 /953 /954
/975 with USA version, code 494
Engine 113 except 113.967 /969
Engine 113.967 /969
Engine 113 with USA version, code 494,
except engine 113.948 /963 /966 /984 /967
/969 /988 /989
Engine 113.948 /963 /966 /984 /967 /969
/988 /989 with USA version, code 494
9
10

Disconnect electrical connectors


Unscrew union nut from pipe (89/2) to
exhaust gas recirculation valve (89)

11

Remove screw (19/1)

11.2

Remove bolts from right combination valve


(6) and left combination valve (6)

12.1

Remove combination valve (6)

12.2

Detach right combination valve (6) and left


combination valve (6) and place to one side

13

Detach intake manifold (19)

14
15

AR09.20-P-1310-01AA

AR09.20-P-1310-01AU
AR09.20-P-1310-01TA
AR09.20-P-1310-01AC

i Counterhold connection fitting when


unscrewing.
n
except engine 113.987 from 24.04.04,
Engine 113.988/ 989

*BA14.20-P-1002-01B

n
Only on engines 113.987 from 24.04.04
Engine 113.988/ 989

*BA09.20-P-1001-01D

n
except engine 113.987 from 24.04.04,
Engine 113.988/ 989
i Installation: Install new gasket
Only engine 113.987 from 24.04.04
Engine 113.988/ 989
i Installation: Replace seals.

*BA09.20-P-1001-01D

i Plug intake ducts. Use centering bolt for


exact positioning of intake manifold and for
centering the gasket (19/3).
n

*BA09.20-P-1001-01D

*112589026200

Replace gasket (19/3)


Install in the reverse order

n Crankcase ventilation, cylinder head cover


Number

Designation

BA01.20-P-1001-01E

Cylinder head cover bolt

Engine
112

Engine
113

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

n Fuel distributor
Number

Designation

BA07.52-P-1001-01A

Fuel feed line to fuel distributor

Engine
112 except
112.945/951/
960/961

Nm

38

n Fuel distributor

62

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar09.20-p-1310a, Remove/install intake manifold


Page 3 of 4
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ...

Number

Designation

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986/988

Engine
113.987

Engine
113.989

BA07.52-P-1001-01A

Fuel feed line to fuel distributor

Nm

38

38

38

Number

Designation

Engines
112, 113

BA09.20-P-1001-01D

Bolt, intake manifold to cylinder head

n Intake manifold

M8

Nm

20

n Exhaust gas recirculation


Number

Designation

BA14.20-P-1002-01B

Union nut, exhaust gas recirculation pipe to


exhaust gas recirculation valve

Nm

Engine
112.910/912/916/
920/921/922/923/
940/941/942/943/
944/945/946/947/
953/972/975

Engine
112.913/
917/949/
954/955/
970/973

Engine
113.940/941/942/
943/944/948/960/9
61/962/964/965/96
6/967/968/969/971
/980/981/982/984/
987/988

Engine
113.963

40

40

40

23

n Exhaust gas recirculation


Number

Designation

BA14.20-P-1002-01B

Acorn nut, exhaust gas recirculation pipe to


exhaust gas recirculation valve

119 589 04 63 00
Pressure hose

Engine
113.989

Nm

40

112 589 02 62 00
Set of dowel bolts

63

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar09.20-p-1310a, Remove/install intake manifold


Page 4 of 4
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ...

AR13.22-P-5700EA
Remove/install generator poly-V belt pulley
3.11.09
ENGINE
111.943 /946 /973 in MODEL 170
ENGINE
104.941, 111.920 /921 /941 /944 /945 /961 /974 /975, 601.913, 604.910 /915, 605.910 /960 in MODEL 202
ENGINE
111.944 /945 /975, 112.940 in MODEL 208
ENGINE
104.945 /995, 111.942 /970, 112.921 /941, 119.985, 602.982, 604.912 /917, 605.912, 606.912 /962 in MODEL 210
1 Collar nut
2 Shaft
3 V-belt belt pulley

P15.40-0201-06

ed
1

Remove/install
Remove alternator

Unscrew collar nut (1)

Remove ribbed V-belt pulley (3)

Install in the reverse order

Engine 112.940 in model 208.


Engine 112.921 /941, 119.985 in Model 210.
Engine 104.945 /995, 111.942 /970, 602.982,
604.912 /917, 605.912, 606.912 /962 in
Model 210.
Engine 104.941, 111.920 /921 /941 /944 /945
/961 /974 /975, 601.913, 604.910 /915,
605.910 /960 in Model 202, engine 111.944
/945 /975 in Model 208.
Engine 111.943 /946 /973 in Model 170.

AR15.40-P-5032EB
AR15.40-P-5032ED
AR15.40-P-5032F

AR15.40-P-5032EA

AR15.40-P-5032G

i Multitooth for retaining the shaft (2)


with a reversible ratchet.
n

*BA15.40-P-1004-01A

*BA15.40-P-1004-01E

i When maintaining alternators after


mileage in excess off
100.000 km, also replace the poly-V belt
pulley (3) at the same time.

n Alternator
Number

Designation

BA15.40-P-1004-01A

Collar nut on poly-V belt


pulley

Nm

Engine
104

Engine
111

Engine
112.91/92/94/
953/954/955/
96/97 except
112.976,
engine
113.94/96/98

80

80

80

64

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar13.22-p-5700ea, Remove/install generator poly-V belt pulley
Page 1 of 2
ENGINE 111.943 /946 /973 in MODEL 170 ENGINE 104.941, 111.920 /921 /941 /944 /945 /961 /974 /975, 601.913, 604.910 /915, 605.910 /960 in MODEL 202 ENGINE 111.944 /945 /975, 112.940 ...

n Alternator
Number

Designation

Engine
119

BA15.40-P-1004-01A

Collar nut on poly-V belt


pulley

Nm

Number

Designation

Engine
601

Engine
602

Engine
604

BA15.40-P-1004-01E

Collar nut to
poly-V belt pulley

80

80

80

Engine
605

Engine
606

80

80

80

n Alternator

Nm

n Alternator
Number

Designation

BA15.40-P-1004-01E

Collar nut to
poly-V belt pulley

Nm

65

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar13.22-p-5700ea, Remove/install generator poly-V belt pulley
Page 2 of 2
ENGINE 111.943 /946 /973 in MODEL 170 ENGINE 104.941, 111.920 /921 /941 /944 /945 /961 /974 /975, 601.913, 604.910 /915, 605.910 /960 in MODEL 202 ENGINE 111.944 /945 /975, 112.940 ...

AR14.10-P-3915AU
Remove/install exhaust manifold
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089
ENGINES 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINES 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINES 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINES 113.984 in MODEL 208.374

21.10.11

Engine 112
156
156/1
156/5

Exhaust manifold
Nuts
Seal

P14.10-0233-11

Engine 113
156
156/1
156/5

Exhaust manifold
Nuts
Seal

P14.10-0249-11

ed
1
2
3.1

Remove/install
Disconnect connector for oxygen sensors
Remove complete exhaust system
Remove air filter

AR14.00-P-5303A
AR49.10-P-7000AU
When removing right exhaust manifold.
i On model 208.370/374/470, 202.033/093,
the air filter always has to be removed. The
air filter is integrated in the cylinder head
cover trim.
Remove air filter by lifting vertically up and
off cylinder head covers.

4
5.1
6.1

7.1
8

Remove ignition coils


Remove washer fluid reservoir for windshield When removing left exhaust manifold.
washer system
Detach left and right engine mount at front
When removing left exhaust manifold.
axle carrier
Remove shield from left engine mount
Attach engine support bracket and raise
engine

n
When removing left exhaust manifold.

AR15.12-P-2003A

*BA22.10-P-1001-01L
AR33.10-P-0100-01AV

Engine support device, engine hoist


gotis://A_01_09.0
66

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar14.10-p-3915au, Remove/install exhaust manifold


Page 1 of 2
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465 ENGINES 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093 ENGINES 113.943 ...

Remove exhaust manifold

i Left side of engine:


Take out exhaust manifold by lifting upwards.
i Right side of engine:
Take out exhaust manifold from bottom.
i Installation: Replace nuts (156/1) and
gaskets (156/5).
n

*BA14.10-P-1001-01B

i If screw/bolts on flange connection of


front exhaust system/ exhaust manifold are
stiff, or thread is
damaged:
Replace rivet nuts in exhaust manifold

10

AR49.10-P-5531-01DA
*103589013900

*BA14.10-P-1002-01B

Install in the reverse order

n Exhaust manifold
Number

Designation

BA14.10-P-1001-01B

Nut on exhaust manifold

BA14.10-P-1002-01B

Flange connection, exhaust manifold/front exhaust


pipes

Engine
112
except
112.951/
976

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986/992/993/
995

Nm

16

16

Nm

20

20

n Engine mounts, engine supports


Number

Designation

BA22.10-P-1001-01L

Screw/bolt, front engine mount to front axle


carrier

Nm

Engine
112.910/920,
113.944
in model
202.026/029/
033/086/089/
093

Engine
112.940,
113.943/984
in model
208.365/
370/374/465/
470

35

35

103 589 01 39 00
Caulking bolt

67

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar14.10-p-3915au, Remove/install exhaust manifold


Page 2 of 2
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465 ENGINES 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093 ENGINES 113.943 ...

AR14.20-P-7662A
Remove/install exhaust gas recirculation valve
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089
ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063
ENGINE 112.923 in MODEL 129.059
ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281
ENGINE 112.941 in MODEL 210.065 /082 /265 /282
ENGINE 112.943 in MODEL 129.064
ENGINE 112.944 in MODEL 220.065 /165
ENGINE 113.940 in MODEL 210.070 /270
ENGINE 113.941 in MODEL 220.070 /170
ENGINE 113.960 in MODEL 215.375, 220.075 /175
ENGINE 113.961 in MODEL 129.068
ENGINE 113.980 in MODEL 210.074 /274
ENGINE 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINE 113.984 in MODES 208.374
ENGINE 112.912 in MODEL 203.061 /261, 209.361 /461
ENGINE 112.946 in MODEL 203.064 /264
ENGINE 112.947 in MODEL 170.465
ENGINE 113.963 in MODEL 230.475
ENGINE 113.968 in MODEL 209.375 /475
ENGINE 112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINE 112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINE 113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINE 113.987 in MODEL 209.376 /476
ENGINE 112.955 in MODEL 209.365 /465
ENGINE 112.916 in MODEL 203.081 /281
ENGINE 112.953 in MODEL 203.084 /284
ENGINE 112.975 in MODEL 220.087 /187
ENGINE 113.948 in MODEL 220.083 /183
ENGINE 113.966 in MODEL 220.084 /184
ENGINE 112.917 in MODEL 211.080 /280
ENGINE 112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINE 113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283
ENGINE 113.988 in MODEL 203.076 /276
ENGINE 113.989 in MODEL 171.473

9.3.10

Shown on engine 112


19
89
89/1
89/2
89/3

Intake manifold
Exhaust gas recirculation valve
Exhaust gas recirculation line
Vacuum reservoir
Union nut

a
b

Vacuum line from intake pipe


Vacuum line

Y31/1

ARF vacuum transducer

P14.20-0263-06

68

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar14.20-p-7662a, Remove/install exhaust gas recirculation valve
Page 1 of 3
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 ENGINE 112.923 in MODEL 129.059 ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL ...

Shown on engine 112


1
2
3
89
89/3

Oil dipstick guide tube


Fuel rail
Plug connection
Exhaust gas recirculation valve
Union nut

Y31/1

ARF vacuum transducer

P14.20-2075-02

P14.20-2076-02

Modification notes
13.5.02

Value changed from 23 to 40 Nm

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of injury to skin and eyes caused by


handling hot or glowing objects.
Remove cover on front side of engine
Remove air filter housing

1
2.1

2.2

Remove engine cover with integrated air


filter

Value in series altered BA14.20-P-1002-01B *BA14.20-P-1002-01B


for engine 112.913/949

Wear safety gloves, protective clothing and


safety glasses, if necessary.
Model 129, 211, 215, 220, 230
Model 171.473
Model 203.076/ 276
Model 209.376/ 476 as of 24.4.04
except model 171.473
Model 203.076 /276,
Model 209.376/ 476 as of 24.4.04

AS00.00-Z-0002-01A

AR09.10-P-1150AC

i The air filter is integrated in the engine


cover. Remove engine cover or air filter by
pulling it vertically up and off the cylinder
head covers.

4.1

4.2

6
7

8
9

Remove hot film mass air flow sensor with


air intake pipe

Remove oil dipstick guide tube (1) and turn


to the side

Detach oil dipstick guide tube (1) from


bracket on exhaust gas recirculation valve
(89) and turn to the side
Remove retaining bracket from oil dipstick
guide tube (1)
Detach fuel distributor rail (2) on right side
and push to the side
Unplug connector (3) from injection valve

Unplug connector on EGR pressure


transducer (Y31/1).
Detach vacuum line (b) to vacuum unit
(89/2) and EGR pressure transducer (Y31/1)

i Installation: Moisten slightly with


lubricating paste retainers on the cylinder
head covers and the sealing ring of the hot
film mass air flow sensor in the air filter
housing.
Lubricating paste
Engine 112.910 /920 /921 /940 /941
Engine 113.940
Engine 112.922 /923 /943 /944 /975
Engine 113.941/ 948/ 960/ 961/ 963/ 966
Engine 113.943 /944 /980 /984
Engine 112.912 /913 /916 /917 /946 /947
/949 /953 /954 /955
Engine 113.967 /968 /969 /987 /988 /989
Model 203, 209

*BR00.45-Z-1002-06A
AR07.07-P-1454A
AR07.07-P-1454AA
AR07.07-P-1454AG
AR07.07-P-1454SV

i Installation: Ensure correct seating of


sealing ring of oil dipstick guide tube (1) in
oil pan top section.
Model 171.473
Model 211
Model 171.473
Model 230.475
Model 203.076/ 276
Model 211
Model 171.473
Model 211
Model 203.076/ 276

69

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar14.20-p-7662a, Remove/install exhaust gas recirculation valve
Page 2 of 3
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 ENGINE 112.923 in MODEL 129.059 ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL ...

10

Unscrew union nut (89/3) on exhaust gas


recirculation valve (89

11

Dismount EGR line (89/1) from intake


manifold (19)

12
13

14

i Model 211, 230.475: pull EGR pipe (89/1)


out of exhaust gas recirculation valve (89).
n
Except model 230.475

*BA14.20-P-1002-01B

*BA14.20-P-1003-01B
n
Unscrew exhaust gas recirculation pipe (89) n
*BA14.20-P-1001-01B
from cylinder head
Remove exhaust gas recirculation valve (89) p Installation: Replace gaskets. Note
length and routing of vacuum line from intake
manifold to EGR [ARF] vacuum transducer
(Y31/1) . Incorrect routing may cause throttle
lever to jam.
Install in the reverse order

n Exhaust gas recirculation


Number

Designation

Engine
112.910/912/916/
920/921/922/923/
940/941/942/943/
944/945/946/947/
953/972/975

Engine
112.913 /
917/949 /
954/955 /
970/973

Engine
113.940/941/942/
943/944/948/960/9
61/962/964/965/96
6/967/968/969/971
/980/981/982/984/
987/988

Engine
113.963

BA14.20-P-1001-01B

Bolt, exhaust gas recirculation valve to


cylinder head

Nm

20

20

20

20

BA14.20-P-1002-01B

Union nut, exhaust gas recirculation pipe to


exhaust gas recirculation valve

Nm

40

40

40

23

BA14.20-P-1003-01B

Bolt, exhaust gas recirculation pipe to


intake pipe

Nm

n Exhaust gas recirculation


Number

Designation

Engine
113.989

BA14.20-P-1001-01B

Bolt, exhaust gas recirculation valve to


cylinder head

Nm

20

BA14.20-P-1002-01B

Union nut, exhaust gas recirculation pipe to


exhaust gas recirculation valve

Nm

40

BA14.20-P-1003-01B

Bolt, exhaust gas recirculation pipe to


intake pipe

Nm

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1002-06A

Designation
Lubricating paste, rubber parts 2.5 kg, DB supply specification 6867.00

Order number
A 000 989 01 60

70

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar14.20-p-7662a, Remove/install exhaust gas recirculation valve
Page 3 of 3
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 ENGINE 112.923 in MODEL 129.059 ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL ...

AR14.30-P-7251A
Remove, install air pump
3.2.09
ENGINE 112, 113 in MODEL 163, 202, 208, 210
ENGINE 112 (except 112.960 /961) in MODEL 170, 203, 209.361 /365 /461 /465 (except 170.466, 203.265 /065)
ENGINE 113.968 in MODEL 209.375 /475
ENGINE 112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINE 112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINE 113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINE 113.987 in MODEL 209.376 /476 up to 23.4.04
ENGINE 112.917 in MODEL 211.080 /280
ENGINE 112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINE 113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283
Shown on engine 112
5
Bolt
5/1
Air hose
M33

Electric air pump

Arrow: Electrical connector

P14.30-0246-06

Fig. item etc.


i
n

Work instructions
Engine cover with integrated air filter

remove

Bolt connecting air pump bracket to timing


case
Bolt

*BA14.30-P-1003-01A
i Pay attention to ground cable.

5/1
M33

Air hose
Electric air pump

i Unplug electrical connector (arrow)

n Air pump
Number

Designation

BA14.30-P-1003-01A

Bolt connecting air pump bracket to timing case

Nm

Engine
112
except
112.960/
961 AMG

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986

Engine
113.987/
988

12

12

71

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar14.30-p-7251a, Remove, install air pump


Page 1 of 1
ENGINE 112, 113 in MODEL 163, 202, 208, 210 ENGINE 112 (except 112.960 /961) in MODEL 170, 203, 209.361 /365 /461 /465 (except 170.466, 203.265 /065) ENGINE 113.968 in MODEL ...

AP15.10-P-1580A
Replace spark plugs
ENGINES
112 in MODELS 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210
ENGINES
113 in MODELS 202, 203, 208, 209, 210

19.5.09

Shown on model 210 with engine 112


1
2

Ignition coil
Spark plug

P15.10-2113-06

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by contact with parts


conducting high voltages.

p
1.1

Do not come into contact with parts that are


under high voltage. Persons with electronic
implants (such as pacemakers) must not
work on the ignition system.
Notes on avoiding damage to ignition system Engine 104, 111, 112, 113, 119, 120, 271
Remove top part of air filter housing

i Only on engines with air filter fitted at


vehicle side.

2.1

Remove hot film mass air flow sensor with


air intake pipe

Remove hot film mass air flow sensor with


air intake pipe

i Only on engines with air filter fitted at


vehicle side.
Engine 112.910 in model 202.026/ 086
Engine 112.920 in model 202.029 /089
Engine 112.940 in model 208.365 /465
Engine 112.911 in model 210.061 /261
Engine 112.921 in model 210.063 /081 /263
/663 /281
Engine 112.941 in model 210.065 /082 /265
/282
Engine 113.940 in model 210.070 /270
Engine 112.947 in model 170.465
Engine 112.912 in Model 203.061/ 261,
209.361/ 461
Engine 112.946 in model 203.064 / 264 /
764
Engine 113.968 in model 209.375 /475
Engine 113.987 in model 209.376 /476
Engine 112.955 in model 209.365 /465
Engine 112.953 in model 203.084 /284
Engine 112.916 in model 203.081 /281
Engine 113.988 in model 203.076 /276
Engine 113.943 in model 208.470 /370
Engine 113.944 in model 202.093 /033
Engine 113.984 in model 208.374 /474
Engine 113.980 in model 210.274 /074

Remove engine cover with integrated air


filter

Remove the ignition coil (1)

AS15.10-Z-0001-01A

AH15.10-P-0002-01D

AR07.07-P-1454A

AR07.07-P-1454SV

AR07.07-P-1454AG

i Pull engine cover with integrated air filter


vertically upwards off the cylinder head
covers.

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ap15.10-p-1580a, Replace spark plugs


ENGINES 112 in MODELS 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210 ENGINES 113 in MODELS 202, 203, 208, 209, 210

72

Page 1 of 3

Engine 112.910 in model 202.086 /026


Engine 112.920 in model 202.029 /089
Engine 112.921 in model 210.063 /081 /263
/281
Engine 112.940 in model 208.465 /365
Engine 112.941 in Model 210.265 /065 /082
/282
Engine 113.940 in model 210.070 /270
Engine 113.960 in model 215.375, 220.175
/075 /875
Engine 113.980 in model 210.074 /274
Engine 113.944 in model 202.033 /093
Engine 113.943 in model 208.470 /370
Engine 113.984 in model 208.374 /474
Engine 112.912 in model 203.261 /061,
209.361
Engine 112.946 in model 203.264 /064
Engine 112.947 in model 170.465
Engine 112.960 in model 170.466
Engine 112.961 in model 203.265 /065
Engine 113.968 in model 209.375
Engine 113.987 in model 209.376 /476
Engine 112.955 in model 209.365
Engine 112.916 in model 203.081 /281
Engine 112.953 in model 203.084 /284
Except engine 112.946 in model 203.764
Engine 112.911 in model 210.061 /261
Engine 112.912 in model 209.461
Engine 112.921 in model 210.663
Engine 112.955 in model 209.465
Engine 113.968 in model 209.475
Engine 113.988 in model 203.076 /276
Disconnect spark plug connectors

i Use double open-end wrench to pry off


spark plug connectors via the cylinder head
cover.
l Double open-ended wrench

g
6

AR15.12-P-2003A

*110589010100

Checking

Check spark plug connector, ignition coil


connectors and ignition lines for damage,
deformation and crack formation
Remove the spark plug (2)

Install in the reverse order

i Replace, if necessary.
n

*BA15.10-P-1001-01A

l Spark plug wrench

*112589010900

n Spark plugs
Number

Designation

BA15.10-P-1001-01A

Spark plugs

112 589 01 09 00

Nm

Engine
104, 110, 111,
113.940/941/942/943/
944/948/960/961/962/
963/964/965/966/967/
968/969/971/980/981/
982/984/986/992/993/
995, 115, 117, 119, 120

Engine
112.910/911/
912/913/914/
915/916/917/
920/921/922/
923/940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/947/
949/951/953/
954/955/960/
961/970/972/
973/975/976

Engine
113.987/988/
990/991

28

28

25

110 589 01 01 00

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ap15.10-p-1580a, Replace spark plugs


ENGINES 112 in MODELS 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210 ENGINES 113 in MODELS 202, 203, 208, 209, 210

73

Page 2 of 3

Spark plug wrench

Open-end wrench, double

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ap15.10-p-1580a, Replace spark plugs


ENGINES 112 in MODELS 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210 ENGINES 113 in MODELS 202, 203, 208, 209, 210

74

Page 3 of 3

AR15.12-P-2184A
Remove/install knock sensors
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089
ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281
ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163
ENGINE 112.923 in MODEL 129.059
ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINE 112.941 in MODEL 210.065 /082 /265 /282
ENGINE 112.942 in MODEL 163.154
ENGINE 112.943 in MODEL 129.064
ENGINE 112.944 in MODEL 220.065 /165
ENGINE 113.940 in MODEL 210.070 /270
ENGINE 113.941 in MODEL 220.070 /170
ENGINE 113.960 in MODEL 215.375, 220.075 /175
ENGINE 113.961 in MODEL 129.068
ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
ENGINE 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINE 113.980 in MODEL 210.074 /274
ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINE 113.984 in MODEL 208.374
ENGINE 113.981 in MODEL 163.174
ENGINE 112.912 in MODEL 203.061 /261, 209.361 /461
ENGINE 112.946 in MODEL 203.064 /264
ENGINE 112.947 in MODEL 170.465
ENGINE 112.960 in MODEL 170.466
ENGINE 113.942 in MODEL 163.172
ENGINE 112.961 in MODEL 203.065 /265
ENGINE 113.965 in MODEL 163.175
ENGINE 113.963 in MODEL 230.475
ENGINE 113.968 in MODEL 209.375 /475
ENGINE 112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINE 112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINE 113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINE 113.987 in MODEL 209.376 /476
ENGINE 112.955 in MODEL 209.365 /465
ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254
ENGINE 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246
ENGINE 112.953 in MODEL 203.084 /284
ENGINE 112.916 in MODEL 203.081 /281
ENGINE 112.973 in MODEL 230.467
ENGINE 112.972 in MODEL 220.067 /167
ENGINE 112.970 in MODEL 163.157
ENGINE 112.975 in MODEL 220.087 /187
ENGINE 113.948 in MODEL 220.083 /183
ENGINE 113.966 in MODEL 220.084 /184
ENGINE 112.917 in MODEL 211.080 /280
ENGINE 112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINE 113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283
ENGINE 113.990 in MODEL 211.076 /276
ENGINE 113.988 in MODEL 203.076 /276
ENGINE 113.993 in MODEL 463.270 /271
ENGINE 113.989 in MODEL 171.473

4.12.06

75

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.12-p-2184a, Remove/install knock sensors


Page 1 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ENGINE ...

Shown on engine 112 in model 220


A16/2

Left knock sensor 2

P15.12-0276-11

ed
1.1

Remove/install

1.2

Remove compressor

Detach knock sensor 1, right and knock


sensor 2, left (A16/2) from cylinder block
Install in the reverse order

Remove intake manifold

All except model,


463 with engine 113.962/982/993
Model 463 with engine 112.945
Model 170.466 with engine 112.960
Model 203.065/265 with engine 112.961
Model 211.076/276 with engine 113.990
Model 463 with Engine 112.945, 113.962/982
Model 170.466 with engine, 112.960
model 203.065/265 with engine, 112.961
model 211.076/276 with engine 113.990
Model 463.270/271 with engine 113.993
n

AR09.20-P-1310A

AR09.20-P-1310AG
AR09.50-P-4705SVK

AR09.50-P-4705GX
*BA15.10-P-1001-02A

n Knock sensors
Number

Designation

BA15.10-P-1001-02A

Bolt securing knock sensor to cylinder


block

Nm

Engine
112.910/911/
912/913/914/
915/916/917/
920/921/922/
923/940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/947/
949/951/953/
954/955/960/
961/970/972/
973/975/976

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986/987/988/
990/991/992/
993/995

Engine
113.989

20

20

20

76

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.12-p-2184a, Remove/install knock sensors


Page 2 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ENGINE ...

AR15.12-P-2133A
Remove/install crankshaft position sensor
ENGINE
112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINE
112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089
ENGINE
112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281
ENGINE
112.922 in MODEL 220.063
ENGINE
112.923 in MODEL 129.059
ENGINE
112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINE
112.941 in MODEL 210.065 /082 /265 /282
ENGINE
112.942 in MODEL 163.154
ENGINE
112.943 in MODEL 129.064
ENGINE
112.944 in MODEL 220.065 /165
ENGINE
113.940 in MODEL 210.070 /270
ENGINE
113.941 in MODEL 220.070 /170
ENGINE
113.960 in MODEL 215.375, 220.075 /175
ENGINE
113.961 in MODEL 129.068
ENGINE
112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
ENGINE
113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINE
113.980 in MODEL 210.074 /274
ENGINE
113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINE
113.984 in MODEL 208.374
ENGINE
113.981 in MODEL 163.174
ENGINE
112.912 in MODEL 203.061 /261, 209.361 /461
ENGINE
112.946 in MODEL 203.064 /264
ENGINE
112.947 in MODEL 170.465
ENGINE
112.960 in MODEL 170.466
ENGINE
113.942 in MODEL 163.172
ENGINE
112.961 in MODEL 203.065 /265
ENGINE
113.965 in MODEL 163.175
ENGINE
113.963 in MODEL 230.475
ENGINE
112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINE
112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINE
113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINE
113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254
ENGINE
113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246
ENGINE
112.955 in MODEL 209.365 /465
ENGINE
112.916 in MODEL 203.081 /281
ENGINE
112.953 in MODEL 203.084 /284
ENGINE
112.973 in MODEL 230.467
ENGINE
112.972 in MODEL 220.067 /167
ENGINE
112.970 in MODEL 163.157
ENGINE
112.975 in MODEL 220.087 /187
ENGINE
113.948 in MODEL 220.083 /183
ENGINE
113.966 in MODEL 220.084 /184
ENGINE
112.917 in MODEL 211.080 /280
ENGINE
112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINE
113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283

9.3.10

Shown on ENGINE 113 in MODEL 220


L5

Crankshaft position sensor

P15.12-0275-11

ed

Remove/install
77

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.12-p-2133a, Remove/install crankshaft position sensor


Page 1 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 ENGINE 112.923 in ...

1.1

Remove engine cover with integrated air


filter

1.2

Remove air filter housing

Remove crankshaft position sensor (L5)

3
4

Install in the reverse order


Perform default initialization.

All except engine 112.960 in model 170.466,


engine 112.961 in model 203.065 /265
i Remove air filter housing by lifting
vertically up and off the cylinder head
covers.
i Installation: Slightly moisten rubber
retainers on cylinder head covers and
sealing ring of hot film mass air flow sensor
in the air filter housing with lubricating paste.
Lubricant paste
*BR00.45-Z-1002-06A
Engine 112.960 in model 170.466
AR09.10-P-1150SVK
Engine 112.961 in model 203.065 /265
*BA15.10-P-1001-03A
n
After replacing crankshaft position sensor
(L5).
i Connect STAR-DIAGNOSIS and select
menu item for control unit adaptations in ME
control unit.

Connect STAR DIAGNOSIS and read out


fault memory

AD00.00-P-2000-04A

n Position sensor
Number

Designation

BA15.10-P-1001-03A

Crankshaft position sensor to engine block

Nm

Engine
112.910/911/
912/913/914/
915/916/917/
920/921/922/
923/940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/947/
949/951/953/
954/955/960/
961/970/972/
973/975/976

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
948/960/961/
962/963/964/
965/966/967/
968/969/971/
980/981/982/
984/986/992/
993/995

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1002-06A

Designation
Lubricating paste, rubber parts 2.5 kg, DB supply specification 6867.00

Order number
A 000 989 01 60

78

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.12-p-2133a, Remove/install crankshaft position sensor


Page 2 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINE 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 ENGINE 112.923 in ...

AR15.12-P-2003A
Remove/install ignition coils
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089
ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281
ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163
ENGINES 112.923 in MODEL 129.059
ENGINES 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINES 112.941 in MODEL 210.065 /082 /265 /282
ENGINES 112.942 in MODEL 163.154
ENGINES 112.943 in MODEL 129.064
ENGINES 112.944 in MODEL 220.065 /165
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463
ENGINES 113.940 in MODEL 210.070 /270
ENGINES 113.941 in MODEL 220.070 /170
ENGINES 113.960 in MODEL 215.375, 220.075 /175 /875
ENGINES 113.961 in MODEL 129.068
ENGINES 113.962 /982 in MODEL 463
ENGINES 113.980 in MODEL 210.074 /274
ENGINES 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINES 113.942 in MODEL 163.172
ENGINES 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINES 113.984 in MODEL 208.374 /474
ENGINES 113.981 in MODEL 163.174
ENGINES 112.912 in MODEL 203.061 /261, 209.361 /461
ENGINES 112.946 in MODEL 203.064 /264
ENGINES 112.947 in MODEL 170.465
ENGINES 112.960 in MODEL 170.466
ENGINES 113.986 in MODEL 215.373, 220.073 /173
ENGINES 112.961 in MODEL 203.065 /265
ENGINES 113.965 in MODEL 163.175
ENGINES 113.963 in MODEL 230.475
ENGINES 113.968 in MODEL 209.375 /475
ENGINES 112.913 in MODEL 211.061 /261
ENGINES 112.949 in MODEL 211.065 /265
ENGINES 113.967 in MODEL 211.070 /270
ENGINES 113.992 in MODEL 230.474
ENGINES 113.987 in MODEL 209.376 /476
ENGINES 112.955 in MODEL 209.365 /465
ENGINES 113.990 in MODEL 211.076 /276
ENGINES 113.991 in MODEL 215.374, 220.074 /174
ENGINES 112.916 in MODEL 203.081 /281
ENGINES 112.953 in MODEL 203.084 /284
ENGINES 112.972 in MODEL 220.067 /167
ENGINES 112.973 in MODEL 230.467
ENGINES 112.970 in MODEL 163.157
ENGINES 112.975 in MODEL 220.087 /187
ENGINES 113.948 in MODEL 220.083 /183
ENGINES 113.966 in MODEL 220.084 /184
ENGINES 112.917 in MODELS 211.080 /280
ENGINES 112.954 in MODEL 211.082 /282
ENGINES 113.969 in MODEL 211.083 /283
ENGINES 113.988 in MODEL 203.076 /276
ENGINES 113.993 in MODEL 463.270 /271
ENGINES 113.989 in MODEL 171.473
ENGINES 113.995 in MODEL 230.472

6.11.09

79

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.12-p-2003a, Remove/install ignition coils


Page 1 of 3
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ...

Shown on engine 112


5/1
5/3
T1/1
T1/2
T1/3
T1/4
T1/5
T1/6
T1/7
T1/8

Spark plug connector


Screw
Cylinder 1 ignition coil
Cylinder 2 ignition coil
Cylinder 3 ignition coil
Cylinder 4 ignition coil
Cylinder 5 ignition coil
Cylinder 6 ignition coil
Cylinder 7 ignition coil
Cylinder 8 ignition coil

Arrow: Identification of the connector

P15.12-2045-05

Modification notes
16.5.06

"Disconnect/connect battery ground line" removed

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Hazard from touching parts which conduct


high voltages

p
1

Notes on avoiding damage to ignition system

Notes on TELE AID emergency call system

Disconnect ground line from battery

3
4.1

4.2

Deactivate service mode in TELE AID


emergency call system

Unclip cover on front side of engine


Remove engine cover with integrated air
filter

Remove air filter housing

Model 203, 209,

Do not touch parts which conduct high


voltages. Persons who wear electronic
implants (e.g. heart pacemakers) should
never perform any work on the ignition
system.

AS15.10-Z-0001-01A

AH15.10-P-0002-01D
i Only on model 463.270 with code: TeleAid car phone emergency call system ET2.
Model 463.243/244/245/247/248/250/
254/270/309/322/323/332/333 TELE AID car
telephone emergency call system ET2
Model 463 except model 463.241/248 with
code 979 special protection version
Model 463.241 with:
-special protection version code 979,
-special protection version FB4 with code
ZS4,
-special protection version FB6 with code
ZS6,
-special protection version FB7 with code
ZS7,
additional battery 100 Ah incl. cutoff relay
CODE E26.
Model 463.248 with:
-special protection version, code 979,
-special protection version FB6, code ZS6,
-special protection version FB7, code ZS7,
-additional battery 100 Ah including cutoff
relay, code E26.
Model 211, 215, 220, 230.475/476
Except model 170.466, 203.065/076/265/276,
209.376/476 from 24.4.04, 211.076/276,
215.374, 220.074/174, 230.474, 463.270/271
i The air filter is integrated in the engine
cover. Remove the engine cover or the air
filter housing by pulling it from the cylinder
head covers vertically in the upward
direction.
Model 170.466, 203.065/265, 211.076/276,
215.374, 220.074/174, 230.474
Model 203.076 /276, 209.376 /476 from
24.4.04, 171.473
Model 463.270/271

Remove screw (5/3)

Detach spark plug connector (5/1) from the


spark plugs

i Pry off spark plug connector (5/1) using


open-end wrench, double over the cylinder
head cover of the spark plugs.

AR82.95-P-0005-03GR
AH82.95-P-0001-01GA

AR54.10-P-0003G
AR54.10-P-0003PV

AR54.10-P-0003PM

AR09.10-P-1150SVK
AR09.10-P-1150AC
AR09.10-P-1150GX
*BA15.10-P-1001-04A

80

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.12-p-2003a, Remove/install ignition coils


Page 2 of 3
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ...

i Installation: Observe the identification of


the connector (arrow) on the cylinder head
cover and the ignition coil of cylinders 1 to 6
or 1 to 8 for the corresponding spark plug
connector (5/1).
l Double open-ended wrench
7

Separate electrical connector of ignition coil


of cylinder 1 to 6 (T1/1 to T1/6) or 1 to 8
(T1/1 to T1/8)
Remove ignition coil of cylinder 1 to 6 (T1/1
to T1/6) or 1 to 8 (T1/1 to T1/8)
Install in the reverse order
Activate Service mode in Tele-Aid
emergency call system

8
9
10
i

Notes on TELE AID emergency call system

*110589010100

i Installation: Install new cable ties.

i Only on model 463.270 with code: Tele- AR82.95-P-0005-03GR


Aid car phone emergency call system ET2.
Model 463.243/244/245/247/248/250/
AH82.95-P-0001-01GA
254/270/309/322/323/332/333 TELE AID car
telephone emergency call system ET2

n Ignition coil
Number

Designation

BA15.10-P-1001-04A

Bolt, ignition coil to cylinder head cover

Engine
112, 113

Nm

110 589 01 01 00
Open-end wrench, double

81

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.12-p-2003a, Remove/install ignition coils


Page 3 of 3
ENGINES 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINES 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINES 112.921 in MODEL 210.063 /081 /263 /281 ENGINES 112.922 in MODEL 220.063 /163 ...

AR15.30-P-7100ED
Remove starter, install
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086
ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089
ENGINE 112.915 in MODEL 202.088
ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINE 113.984 in MODEL 208.374
1
2
3
4
M1

15.2.12

Electric cable circuit 30


Electric cable circuit 50
Bolts
Nut
Starter

P15.30-0217-06

Modification notes
6.7.00

Value changed from 16 Nm to 14 Nm

6.7.00

Value changed from 10 Nm to 6 Nm

6.7.00

Value changed from 58 Nm to 42 Nm

ed

Remove/Install

a Danger!

Risk of explosion caused by escaping


oxyhydrogen gas. Risk of injury caused by
caustic burns to eyes, skin and mucous
membranes from battery electrolyte (contains
diluted sulfuric acid) or metal spatter due to
short circuit. Risk of burn injuries caused
by short circuit. Risk of poisoning caused
by swallowing battery electrolyte (contains
diluted sulfuric acid) or absorption of lead
over the skin or orifices
Disconnect ground line from battery

p
2
3

Figure in BA15.30-P-1001-01A for engine


112, 113 modified
Figure in BA15.30-P-1002-01A for engine
112, 113 modified
Figure in BA15.30-P-1003-01A for engine
112, 113 modified

*BA15.30-P-1001-01A

No fire, sparks, open flames or smoking.


Wear acid-resistant gloves and clothing and
safety glasses with side guards.
Do not place any conductive objects on the
battery and avoid any short circuit from
battery positive to ground.
Only fill liquid battery electrolyte (diluted
sulfuric acid) into suitable and appropriately
marked containers.

AS54.10-Z-0001-01A

p Insulate clamping device of the ground


line in order to prevent inadvertent contact
with the ground point of the battery.

AR54.10-P-0003A

*BA15.30-P-1002-01A
*BA15.30-P-1003-01A

Notes on battery

AH54.10-P-0001-01A

Remove lower engine compartment paneling


Remove right engine mount
Engine 112.915
Engine 112 except engine 112.915
Engine 113
Dismount electrical lines (1, 2), to do this,
n Nut, terminal 30 connection
unscrew bolts (4)

AR61.20-P-1105AB
AR22.10-P-1100AV
AR22.10-P-1100MV
*BA15.30-P-1001-01A

n Nut of connection circuit50

*BA15.30-P-1002-01A

Remove screws (3)

*BA15.30-P-1003-01A

6
7
8
9

Take starter (M1) down and out


Install in the reverse order
Perform function check
Render electrical system operational

i Perform basic programming

AR00.19-P-0200C
82

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.30-p-7100ed, Remove starter, install


Page 1 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.915 in MODEL 202.088 ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465 ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL ...

n Starter
Number

Designation

Engine
112
except
112.951,
113.94/
96/98

BA15.30-P-1001-01A

Nut of connection of circuit 30

Nm

14

BA15.30-P-1002-01A

Nut of connection circuit 50

Nm

BA15.30-P-1003-01A

Bolt of starter to crankcase

Nm

42

83

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.30-p-7100ed, Remove starter, install


Page 2 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.915 in MODEL 202.088 ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465 ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL ...

AR22.10-P-1100AV
Remove/install engine mount
ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086
ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089
ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093
1

Engine mount

Shields

7.11.08

3, 4 Bolt

P22.10-2005-12

10
11
23
26
46

Track rods
Drag link
Steering gear
Relay lever
Steering damper

P46.10-0203-01

ed
1

Remove/install
Remove engine cover or air filter

i On model 202.033/093 the air filter is


integrated in the engine trim panel.
Remove engine cover or air filter by pulling
it vertically up and off cylinder head covers.

Disconnect/connect battery ground line

i Only necessary if the right engine mount


is removed.

AR54.10-P-0003A

Installation: After connecting, read fault


memory, encode radio and normalize power
windows.
Vehicles with stationary heater: adjust time
display on stationary heater.
3
4
5
6

Put on engine carrier arm


AR33.10-P-0100-01AV
Unscrew bolts (4) connecting engine mount n
*BA22.10-P-1001-01L
(1) to front axle carrier
Unbolt steering damper (46) at drag link (11) n
*BA46.40-P-1001-03A
Unscrew nuts of drag link (11) at Pitman arm i Counterhold ball studs, if necessary, with
and at relay lever (26)
hexagon socket wrench.
Installation:
p Replace self-locking nuts.
n

*BA46.40-P-1001-04A

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar22.10-p-1100av, Remove/install engine mount


ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093

84

Page 1 of 3

Use puller to press drag link (11) off at


pitman arm and at relay lever (26) and
detach

8
9

Remove shield at relay lever (26)


Unscrew bolts (3) connecting engine mount
(1) to engine support

10

Raise engine at front lifting eye

11

Remove shields (2)

12

Remove engine mounts (1)

Environmental protection regulations for


disposal of engine mounts
Install in the reverse order
Read out fault memory and erase

13
14

p Install thrust piece at relevant joint.


Installation:
Clean tapers free of grease and press ball
joints firmly into the drag links.
Inspect play of joint, rubber boot, replace
drag link, if necessary.
Remove drag link.
l

AR46.40-P-0100C
*129589106300

*202589013300

*BA22.10-P-1004-01L

*112589001600

p Ensure that rear of engine does not


touch the body!
Do not over-tension coolant hoses and
ground cable (W11/4 engine support left
front axle carrier)!
Installation:
The recesses in shields must be located in
the anti-twist locks of the engine supports.
Installation:
p The anti-twist locks (arrows) at engine
mounts (1) must fit in retaining grooves
(arrows) of the engine supports.
Installation:
p On model 202.033/093 (AMG) harder
engine mounts are fitted than in the standard
vehicle; pay attention to this when replacing
engine mounts!
Dispose engine mounts into mixed scrap.

i Only necessary if the right engine mount


is removed.
Stored faults which can result from cables
being disconnected or from simulation during
removal and installation or test work, have to
be processed and erased in the fault
memories after completing the work.
Diagnosis Manual Volume 2, Index 0:
Connecting and using test equipment

n Engine mounts, engine supports


Number

Designation

BA22.10-P-1001-01L

Bolt, front engine mounts to front axle carrier

BA22.10-P-1004-01L

Bolt, front engine mount to engine support

Engines
112.910/920,
113.944 in
models
202.026/029/033/
086/089/093

Engine 112.940,
113.943/984
in model
208.365/
370/374/465/470

Nm

35

35

Nm

55

55

n Steering damper
Number

Designation

BA46.40-P-1001-03A

Steering damper to drag link

Nm

Model 202

Model 208

40

40

n Drag link
Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar22.10-p-1100av, Remove/install engine mount
ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093

85

Page 2 of 3

Number

Designation

BA46.40-P-1001-04A

Self-locking nuts of drag link

202 589 01 33 00
Puller

129 589 10 63 00
Thrust piece

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Model 202

Model 208

50

50

112 589 00 16 00
Connecting piece

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar22.10-p-1100av, Remove/install engine mount


ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093

86

Page 3 of 3

AR15.40-P-5032EB
Remove/install alternator
ENGINE
112.910 /920 in MODEL 202
ENGINE
112.940, 113.943 /984 in MODEL 208

3.11.09

Shown on engine 112


1
2
3
4
G2

Electrical cable, circuit 30 (B+)


Electric cable, circuit. 61 (D+)
Bolts
Cover sleeve
Alternator

P15.40-2003-06

Modification notes
14.4.00

Value changed from 15 Nm to 18 Nm

14.4.00

Value changed from 4 Nm to 5 Nm

ed
1

2
3

Figure in BA15.40-P-1001-01A for engine


*BA15.40-P-1001-01A
112, 113 modified
Specification in BA15.40-P-1002-01A revised *BA15.40-P-1002-01A
for 112, 113 engines

Remove/install
i Insulate cable lug of ground line to
provide protection from unintentional contact
of disconnected ground line.
Remove lower engine compartment paneling Model 202
Model 208
Remove poly-V belt
Engine 113.943 in model 208
Engine 112.910/ 920 in model 202
Engine 112.940, 113.984 in model 208
Disconnect electrical line circuit 30 (B+)(1)
n
and electrical line circuit 61 (D+) (2).
Disconnect battery ground line

Remove alternator screws (3)

6
7

Remove alternator (G2) downwards


Install in the reverse sequence

AR54.10-P-0003A

AR61.20-P-1105A
AR13.22-P-1202B
AR13.22-P-1202BA
*BA15.40-P-1001-01A

*BA15.40-P-1002-01A

*BA15.40-P-1003-01A

n Alternator
Number

Designation

BA15.40-P-1001-01A

Nut, circuit B+ to alternator

Nm

18

BA15.40-P-1002-01A

Nut, circuit D+ to alternator

Nm

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.40-p-5032eb, Remove/install alternator


ENGINE 112.910 /920 in MODEL 202 ENGINE 112.940, 113.943 /984 in MODEL 208

Engine
112.91/92/94/
953/954/955/
96/97 except
112.976,
engine
113.94/96/98

87

Page 1 of 2

BA15.40-P-1003-01A

Alternator bolt

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar15.40-p-5032eb, Remove/install alternator


ENGINE 112.910 /920 in MODEL 202 ENGINE 112.940, 113.943 /984 in MODEL 208

Nm

42

88

Page 2 of 2

AP18.00-P-0101AE

ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE
ENGINE

1
2
3
4
5
6

Engine oil and filter change

10.12.13

112.910/915/920 in MODEL 202


112.911/914/921/941 in MODEL 210
112.912/946 in MODEL 203
112.912/955 in MODEL 209
112.913/917/949/954 in MODEL 211
112.922/944/972/975 in MODEL 220
112.923/943 in MODEL 129
112.940 in MODEL 208
112.942/970 in MODEL 163
112.947 in MODEL 170
112.973 in MODEL 230

Oil filter screw-on cover


Oil filter element
Sealing rings
Oil dipstick
Oil measuring pipe
Engine cover

P18.00-2365-06

a Danger !

a Danger !

Risk of injury to skin and eyes due to


handling of engine oil. Risk of poisoning
caused by swallowing engine oil

Wear protective gloves, protective clothing


and safety glasses.
Do not fill engine oil into beverage
containers.
Risk of accident from vehicle starting off by Secure vehicle to prevent it from starting off
itself when engine running. Risk of injury
by itself. Wear closed and snug-fitting work
(bruises and burns) resulting from working on clothes. Do not touch hot or rotating parts.
the engine while it is being started or when it
is running.
Notes on engine oil and filter changes

e
1

Remove

2.1

Pull oil dipstick (4) out of oil measuring


pipe (5) and wipe with a lint-free cloth

2.2

allow engine to warm up

Pull stop plug out of oil measuring pipe (5)

Suction off engine oil using oil measuring


pipe (5)

Remove engine cover (6)

AS18.00-Z-0001-01A

AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

AH18.00-P-0104-01A

i Coolant temperature min. 80 C.


If installed
i The oil dipstick (4) and oil measuring
pipe (5) can be at the front or rear of the
engine (depending on the model series).
If installed
i Stop plugs and oil measuring pipe (5) can
be at the front or rear of the engine
(depending on the model series).
Engine oil suction unit - stationary
gotis://S_18.1_01.1
Engine oil suction unit - mobile
gotis://S_18.1_02.0
If the oil filter threaded cap (1) is not
accessible.
89

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ap18.00-p-0101ae, Engine oil and filter change
Page 1 of 3
ENGINE 112.910/915/920 in MODEL 202 ENGINE 112.911/914/921/941 in MODEL 210 ENGINE 112.912/946 in MODEL 203 ENGINE 112.912/955 in MODEL 209 ENGINE 112.913/917/949/954 in ...

Remove oil filter threaded cap (1)

6
7
8

Remove oil filter threaded cap (1)


Replace oil filter element (2)
Replace sealing ring (3)
Install

i Unscrew the oil filter threaded cap (1)


(depending on the version) using a l
socket wrench bit.
l Wrench socket

d
9

Install oil filter threaded cap (1)

10
11.1
11.2
12

Remove engine oil extractor


Insert clean oil dipstick (4) into oil measuring
pipe (5)
Insert stop plug into oil measuring pipe (5)
pour in engine oil

*103589020900

i Unscrew the oil filter threaded cap (1)


(depending on the version) using l socket.
n Screw cap at oil filter

*BA18.20-P-1001-01D

l Wrench socket

*103589020900

If installed
If installed
p use only approved engine oils.
Engine damage can occur otherwise.
j Engine oil

g
13

*BF18.00-P-1001-01H

Check
Run engine until it is at operating
temperature, and check for leaktightness

i Coolant temperature min. 80 C.


in the event of leakage:
Determine and rectify cause, subject to
separate repair order.

14
15
16.1

16.2

Turn off engine


Pull stop plug out of oil measuring pipe (5)
Check engine oil level using oil dipstick (4);
correct if necessary

Check engine oil level using a dipstick,


correct if necessary

If installed
Check engine oil level using on-board oil
dipstick (4)
MODEL 203, 209, 211, 230, ENGINE
112.922/944/972 in MODEL 220

AP18.00-P-1811MP

i Insert oil dipstick (4) all the way into the


oil measuring pipe (5) and leave for at
least 3 s.
Check engine oil level with special tool
MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 210,
ENGINE 112.975 in MODEL 220

AP18.00-P-1810MA

i l Insert dipstick all the way into guide


tube (5) and hold there for at least 3
seconds.
l Measuring rod
d
17
18

*120589072100

Install
Insert stop plug into oil measuring pipe (5)
Install engine cover (6)

If the engine cover (6) was removed

n Oil filter
Number

Designation

BA18.20-P-1001-01D

Screw cap at oil filter

Nm

ENGINE
112.910/911/912/91
3/914/915/916/917/9
20/921/922/923/940/
941/942/943/944/94
5/946/947/949/951/9
53/954/955/960/961/
970/972/973/975
25

Liter

ENGINE 112
(except
112.916/953/975)
shortened
maintenance
interval
8,0

Engine lubrication

Number

Designation

BF18.00-P-1001-01H

Engine oil

Filling capacity with


oil filter

ENGINE 112
(except
112.916/953/975)
Maximum
maintenance
interval
8,0
90

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ap18.00-p-0101ae, Engine oil and filter change
Page 2 of 3
ENGINE 112.910/915/920 in MODEL 202 ENGINE 112.911/914/921/941 in MODEL 210 ENGINE 112.912/946 in MODEL 203 ENGINE 112.912/955 in MODEL 209 ENGINE 112.913/917/949/954 in ...

Filling capacity
without oil filter
Sheet
Sheet
Sheet

Liter

7,5

7,5

BB00.40-P-0229-01A BB00.40-P-0229-03A BB00.40-P-0229-05A BB00.40-P-0229-05


A

Engine lubrication

Number

Designation

BF18.00-P-1001-01H

Engine oil

103 589 02 09 00
Wrench socket

Filling capacity with


oil filter
Filling capacity
without oil filter
Sheet
Sheet
Sheet

Liter

ENGINE 112.975
Verkrztes
Wartungsintervall
8,0

ENGINE 112.975
Maximales
Wartungsintervall
8,0

Liter

7,5

7,5

BB00.40-P-0229-01A BB00.40-P-0229-03A BB00.40-P-0229-05A BB00.40-P-0229-05


A

120 589 07 21 00
Measuring rod

91

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ap18.00-p-0101ae, Engine oil and filter change
Page 3 of 3
ENGINE 112.910/915/920 in MODEL 202 ENGINE 112.911/914/921/941 in MODEL 210 ENGINE 112.912/946 in MODEL 203 ENGINE 112.912/955 in MODEL 209 ENGINE 112.913/917/949/954 in ...

AR20.10-P-1271B
Remove/install coolant pump
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
ENGINES 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220
ENGINES 113.962 in MODELS 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254
ENGINES 113 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220
ENGINES 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246
ENGINES 113.989 in MODEL 171.473

3.11.09

Shown on engine 112


1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11

Viscous fan
Poly-V-belt
Fan shroud
Coolant hose
Coolant hose
Coolant hose to oil-water heat
exchanger
Coolant pump belt pulley
Coolant pump
Coolant pump gasket
Shock absorber
Bolts

P20.10-0242-06

Modification notes
16.12.03

Value changed from 10 Nm to 9 Nm

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off the lifting platform.

Lift/jack up vehicle

a Danger!

3.1

Value in BA20.10-P-1002-01M modified on


engine 112.910/911/912/913/914/915/
916/917/920/921/922/923/940/941/942/
943/944/945/946/947/949/953/954/
955/960/961/970/972/973/975

*BA20.10-P-1002-01M

Align vehicle between columns of lifting


platform and position four support plates at
the lifting platform support points specified by
vehicle manufacturer.
Models 129, 170, 202, 208, 210, 220
Model 163
Model 171
Model 203, 209
Model 463
Keep body parts and limbs well clear of
moving parts.

AS00.00-Z-0010-01A

Risk of injury caused by fingers being


pinched or crushed when removing,
installing or aligning hoods, doors, trunk lids,
liftgates or sliding roof
Open engine hood
Model 129
Model 163.154 /172 up to VIN A145272
Model 163.154 /172 up to VIN X708318
Model 163.154 /172 from VIN A145273
Model 163.154 /172 from VIN X708319
Model 163.157/ 174/ 175
Model 170
Model 171.4
Model 202
Model 203
Model 208 / 210
Model 209
Model 220
Model 463
Unclip cover on front side of engine
i Only model 220.

AR00.60-P-1000GH
AR00.60-P-1000V
AR00.60-P-1000P
AR00.60-P-1000G
AS00.00-Z-0011-01A

AR88.40-P-1000GH
AR88.40-P-1000GI

AR88.40-P-1000G
AR88.40-P-1000V
AR88.40-P-1000E
AR88.40-P-1000P
AR88.40-P-1000F
AR88.40-P-1000Q
AR88.40-P-1000M
AR88.40-P-1000GG
92

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-1271b, Remove/install coolant pump


Page 1 of 6
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINES 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113.962 in MODELS 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 ...

4.1

Remove engine cover or air filter

5.1

Partially remove air filter housing

6.1

Remove viscous fan (1)

7.1

Remove fan shroud (3)

i All except models 170.466, 171.473,


203.065 /265, 203.076 /276, 209.376 /476
from 24.4.04.
Engine 112.960 in model 170.466
AR09.10-P-1150SVK
Engine 112.961 in model 203.065/ 265
Engine 113.987 in model 209.376 /476 as of AR09.10-P-1150AC
24.4.04
Engine 113.988 in model 203.076 /276
Engine 113.989 in model 171.473
All except models 163.174 /175, 170,
AR20.40-P-5660C
171.473, 203, 208.365 /465, 209, 220
i Right-hand thread!

8.1

a Danger!

i On vehicles fitted with suction fan,


separate the plug connection of the suction
fan before removing the fan shroud (3).
Model 171.473 with engine 113.989
Model 463 with engine 112.945, 113.962
/982
Model 220 with engine 112, 113
Remove electric fan
Model 163 with engines 113.965/ 981
Model 170 with engine 112.947 /960
Model 171.473 with engine 113.989
Model 203.076 /276
Model 203 with engines 112.912 /916 /946
/953 /961
Model 209 with engines 112.912 /955,
113.968 /987.
Model 208.365 / 465
Risk of injury to skin and eyes caused by
Do not open cooling system unless coolant
scalding from contact with hot coolant spray. temperature is below 90C. Open cap slowly
Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
and release the pressure. Do not pour
coolant.
coolant into beverage containers.
Wear protective gloves, protective clothing
and safety glasses.
Drain coolant at radiator
i Model 163: For draining coolant, detach
bottom coolant line at radiator or at coolant
pump.

AR20.40-P-6800VT
AR20.40-P-6800V
AR20.40-P-6800AB
AR20.40-P-5000GH
AR20.40-P-5000SV
AR20.40-P-5000V
AR20.40-P-5000AC
AR20.40-P-5000PV

AS20.00-Z-0001-01A

p Installation: On model 163 replace


radiator connection of hose clamps to
coolant hose, otherwise this can cause a
damage to the bolt/thread.
n Hose clamp

*BA20.20-P-1004-01A

i Collect coolant
i Disposal of coolants: observe legal
regulations or local wastewater requirements!
Refer to Environmental Protection Catalog
issued by MBVD/PWU for locations in
Germany.
Model 129, 163, 202, 208, 210, 220 with
AR20.00-P-1142HA
engine 112
Model 220, 210, 208, 202, 163, 129 with
engine 113
Model 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249
/254 with engine 113.962
Model 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
with engine 112.945.
Model 463.243 /246 with engine 113.982
Model 170.465 with engine 112.947
AR20.00-P-1142SV
Model 170.466 with engine 112.960
Model 171.473 with engine 113.989
AR20.00-P-1142PV
Model 203.061 /261 with engine 112.912
Model 203.064 /264 /764 with engine
112.946
Model 203.065 /265 with engine 112.961
Model 203.076 /276 with engine 113.988
Model 203.081 /281 with engine 112.916
Model 203.084 /284 with engine 112.953
Model 209.361 /461 with engine 112.912
Model 209.365 /465 with engine 112.955
Model 209.375 /475 with engine 113.968
Model 209.376 /476 with engine 113.987
10

Remove poly-V belt (2)

i Lock tensioner pulley with drift or pin


(diameter 5 mm).

93

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-1271b, Remove/install coolant pump


Page 2 of 6
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINES 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113.962 in MODELS 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 ...

11.1

Remove shock absorber (10)

12

Remove poly-V-belt tensioning device

Model 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250


with engine 112.945.
Model 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249
/254 with engine 113.962
Model 463.243 /246 with engine 113.982
Model 129, 163 with engine 112
Model 129, 202, 208.370 /470, 210 with
engine 113
Model 163 with engine 113 except 113.965
/981
Model 202, 208, 210, 220 with engine 112
Model 220 with engine 113 except 220.074
/174
Model 163.174 with engine 113.981
Model 163.175 with engine 113.965
Model 208.374 /474 with engine 113
Model 220.074 / 174
Model 170.465 with engine 112.947
Model 170.466 with engine 112.960
Model 203.065 /265 with engine 112.961
Model 171.473 with engine 113.989
Model 203.061 /261 with engine 112.912
Model 203.064 /264 /764 with engine
112.946
Model 203.076 /276 with engine 113.988
Model 203.081 /281 with engine 112.916
Model 203.084 /284 with engine 112.953
Model 209.361 /461 with engine 112.912
Model 209.365 /465 with engine 112.955
Model 209.375 /475 with engine 113.968
Model 209.376 /476 with engine 113.987
Model 210, 203, 209, 202, 170, 129 with
manual transmission
Model 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
with engine 112.945.
Model 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249
/254 with engine 113.962
Model 463.243 /246 with engine 113.982
Model 129, 163 with engine 112
Model 129, 202, 208, 210 with engine 113
Model 163 with engine 113 except 113.965
/981
Model 163.174 with engine 113.981
Model 163.175 with engine 113.965
Model 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 with
engine 112
Model 171.473 with engine 113.989
Model 203, 209, 220 with engine 113

AR13.22-P-1202B

AR13.22-P-1202BA

AR13.22-P-1202R
AR13.22-P-1202SV
AR13.22-P-1202SVK
AR13.22-P-1202PV

AR13.25-P-3200B

AR13.25-P-3200BA

i Check condition of coolant hoses and


hose clamps, replace if necessary.

13

Disconnect coolant hose (4, 5)

14.1

Disconnect coolant hose (6) at oil-water heat i All except model 171.473.
exchanger
i Check condition of coolant hose and
hose clamp; replace if necessary.
iOnly model 171.473.

15.1

Remove bolts from oil lines on oil filter

16.1

Remove bolts from oil lines brackets and lay


oil lines with brackets to one side

i Only model 171.473.

17.1

Remove bracket with switchover valve and


pressure sensor and place to one side
Take off belt pulley of coolant pump (7)

i Only model 171.473.

n Bolt of oil line to oil filter housing

n Bolt, oil line bracket

18

*BA18.20-P-1003-01D

*BA18.20-P-1004-01D

i Engine 112:
n Belt pulley on coolant pump

*BA20.10-P-1002-01M

i Engine 113, except 113.987 /988 /989


/991:
n Belt pulley on coolant pump

*BA20.10-P-1002-01C

i Engines 113.987 /988 /989 /991:


n Belt pulley on coolant pump

*BA20.10-P-1002-01L

i Engine 113.989:
l Counterholder
19

Remove coolant pump (8)

*113589004000

i Installation: Replace gasket of coolant


pump (9).
i Engine 112:
n Self-tapping screw for coolant pump to
timing case

*BA20.10-P-1001-01M

94

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-1271b, Remove/install coolant pump


Page 3 of 6
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINES 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113.962 in MODELS 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 ...

i Engine 113 except 113.987 /988 /989


/991:
n Self-tapping screw for coolant pump to
timing case

*BA20.10-P-1001-01C

i Engines 113.987 /988 /989 /991:


n Bolt, coolant pump to timing case

*BA20.10-P-1001-01L

i Engine 112, 113:

20
21

Install in the reverse order


Inspecting cooling system for leaks

n Alternator screw

*BA15.40-P-1003-01A

l External torx set

*001589760900

i All except models 170, 171.473, 203, 209, AR20.00-P-1010HA


220.074 /174
Model 170, 171.473, 203, 209
AR20.00-P-1010P
Model 220.074 / 174
AR20.00-P-1010RVK

n Alternator
Number

Designation

Engine
112.91/92/94/
953/954/955/
96/97 except
112.976,
engine
113.94/96/98

Engine
113.991
in model
215, 220

BA15.40-P-1003-01A

Alternator bolt

Nm

42

Number

Designation

Engine
113.989

BA18.20-P-1003-01D

Bolt, oil line to oil filter housing

Nm

BA18.20-P-1004-01D

Bolt for oil line bracket

Nm

n Oil filter

n Coolant pump, coolant thermostat


Number

Designation

BA20.10-P-1001-01M

Self-tapping bolt, connecting coolant


pump to timing case

Engine
112.910/911/912
/913/914/915/
916/917/920/
921/922/923/
940/941/942/
943/944/945/
946/947/949/
953/954/955/
960/961/970/
972/973/975

Thread not pretapped

M6

Nm

14

Thread not pretapped

M8

Nm

35

Thread pretapped

M6

Nm

10

95

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-1271b, Remove/install coolant pump


Page 4 of 6
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINES 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113.962 in MODELS 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 ...

Thread pretapped
BA20.10-P-1002-01M

M8

Belt pulley on coolant pump

Nm

25

Nm

n Coolant pump, coolant thermostat


Number

Designation

BA20.10-P-1001-01C

Self-tapping bolt, connecting coolant Thread not prepump to timing case


tapped

M6

Nm

14

Thread not pretapped

M8

Nm

35

Thread pre-tapped

M6

Nm

10

Thread pre-tapped

M8

Nm

25

Nm

10

BA20.10-P-1002-01C

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/965/966/
967/968/969/
980/981/982/
984/986/992
993/995

Belt pulley on coolant pump

n Coolant pump, coolant thermostat


Number

Designation

BA20.10-P-1001-01L

Bolt, coolant pump to timing case

BA20.10-P-1002-01L

Engine
113.987/988/
990/991

Engine
113.989

M6

Nm

14

14

M8

Nm

20

20

Nm

Belt pulley on coolant pump

n Radiator, coolant hoses


Number

Designation

BA20.20-P-1004-01A

Hose clamp

Engine
112.942/
970,
113.942/
965/981

Nm

96

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-1271b, Remove/install coolant pump


Page 5 of 6
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINES 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113.962 in MODELS 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 ...

001 589 76 09 00
External Torx set

113 589 00 40 00
Counterholder

97

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-1271b, Remove/install coolant pump


Page 6 of 6
ENGINES 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINES 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 220 ENGINES 113.962 in MODELS 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 ...

AR20.10-P-2460B
Remove/install coolant thermostat
ENGINE 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 208, 209.361 /365 /461 /465, 210, 211.061 /261 /065 /265, 220
ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250
ENGINE 113 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210, 211.070 /270, 220, 230.475
ENGINE 113.962 in MODEL 463.206 /240 /241 /247 /248 /249 /254
ENGINE 113.982 in MODEL 463.243 /246
ENGINE 113.989 in MODEL 171.473

4.12.06

Shown on engine 112


1
2
3
4
5
6

Coolant thermostat housing


Sealing ring
Bolts
Hose clamp
Coolant hose
Radiator

P20.10-0243-06

Modification notes
1.9.04

Value changed from 10 Nm to 14 Nm

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of injury caused by fingers being


pinched or crushed when removing,
installing or aligning hoods, doors, trunk lids,
tailgates or sliding roof.
Open engine hood
Risk of injury to skin and eyes caused by
scalding from contact with hot coolant spray.
Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
coolant.

1
a Danger!

Drain coolant at radiator (6)

Value in row 1003 changed for engine


112.910/911/912/913/914/915/916/917/
920/921/922/923/940/941/942/943/944/
945/946/947/949/953/954/955/960/961/
970/972/973/975

*BA20.10-P-1003-01M

Keep body parts and limbs well clear of


moving parts.

AS00.00-Z-0011-01A

Do not open cooling system unless coolant


AS20.00-Z-0001-01A
temperature is below 90C. Open cap slowly
and release the pressure. Do not pour
coolant into beverage containers.
Wear protective gloves, protective clothing
and safety glasses.
i Model 163: For draining coolant, detach
bottom coolant line at radiator or at coolant
pump.
p Installation: On model 163 replace
radiator connection of hose clamps to
coolant hose, otherwise this can cause a
damage to the bolt/thread.
n Model 163

*BA20.20-P-1004-01A

i Collect coolant
i Disposal of coolants: observe legal
regulations or local wastewater requirements!
Refer to Environmental Protection Catalog
issued by MBVD/PWU for locations in
Germany.

98

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-2460b, Remove/install coolant thermostat


Page 1 of 3
ENGINE 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 208, 209.361 /365 /461 /465, 210, 211.061 /261 /065 /265, 220 ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 113 in MODEL 129, ...

p
3
4

Notes on coolant
Unclip cover on front side of engine
Remove engine cover with integrated air
filter

Engine 112 in model 220, 208, 211, 163, 210, AR20.00-P-1142HA


129, 202
Engine 113 in model 211, 163, 208, 202, 210,
220, 129
Engine 113.962 in Model 463.240 /241 /248
/254 /206 /247 /249
Engine 112.945 in model 463.233 /244 /209
/232 /245 /250
Engine 113.982 in model 463.246 /243
Engine 113.963 in model 230.475
AR20.00-P-1142RVK
Engine 112.912 in model 209.361 /461
AR20.00-P-1142PV
Engine 112.955 in model 209.365 /465
Engine 113.968 in model 209.375 /475
Engine 113.987 in MODEL 209.376/ 476
Engine 113.988 in model 203.076/ 276
Engine 113.989 in model 171.473
AH20.00-N-2080-01A
Model 211, 220
Except model 211, 230
Model 171.473
Model 203.076/ 276
Model 209.376/ 476 as of 24.4.04

AR09.10-P-1150AC

i For model 463, 220, 210.074 /274,


208.370 /374 /470, 209.361 /365 /375 /376
/461 /465 /475 /476, 202.033 /093, 129, the
air filter is integrated in the engine cover.
Remove engine cover or air filter by pulling
it vertically up and off the cylinder head
covers.
5

Detach coolant hose (5)

6
7

Remove poly-V belt from guide pulley


Unscrew bolts (3), remove coolant
thermostat housing (1) with coolant
thermostat

i Inspect condition of coolant hose (5) and


hose clamp (4), replace if necessary.
Model 171.473 with engine 113.989

AR13.22-P-1202PV

pThe coolant thermostat must not be


removed from the housing. Otherwise it will
be destroyed. Re-installation is not possible.
The housing is supplied together with the
coolant thermostat for repair purposes.
i Installation: Install new sealing ring (2).

8
9

Install in the reverse order


Inspect cooling system for leaks

n Engine 112

*BA20.10-P-1003-01M

n Engine 113 except 113.987 /988 /989


/991

*BA20.10-P-1003-01C

n Engine 113.987 /988 /989 /991

*BA20.10-P-1003-01L

Model 129, 163, 202, 208, 210, 211, 463


Model 220 except 220.074 /174
Model 171.473
Model 203.076/ 276
Model 209 with engine 112, 113
Model 220.074/ 174
Model 230.475

AR20.00-P-1010HA
AR20.00-P-1010P

AR20.00-P-1010RVK

n Radiator, coolant hoses


Number

Designation

BA20.20-P-1004-01A

Hose clamp

Engine
112.942/
970,
113.942/
965/981

Nm

n Coolant pump, coolant thermostat

99

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-2460b, Remove/install coolant thermostat


Page 2 of 3
ENGINE 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 208, 209.361 /365 /461 /465, 210, 211.061 /261 /065 /265, 220 ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 113 in MODEL 129, ...

Number

Designation

BA20.10-P-1003-01C

Bolt for coolant thermostat housing

Engine
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/965/966/
967/968/969/
980/981/982/
984/986/992
993/995

M6

Nm

10

n Coolant pump, coolant thermostat


Number

Designation

BA20.10-P-1003-01M

Bolt for coolant thermostat housing

Engine
112.910/911/912
/913/914/915/
916/917/920/
921/922/923/
940/941/942/
943/944/945/
946/947/949/
953/954/955/
960/961/970/
972/973/975

M6

Nm

14

n Coolant pump, coolant thermostat


Number

Designation

BA20.10-P-1003-01L

Bolt for coolant thermostat housing

M6

Nm

Engine
113.987/988/
990/991

Engine 113.989

14

14

100

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar20.10-p-2460b, Remove/install coolant thermostat


Page 3 of 3
ENGINE 112 in MODEL 129, 163, 202, 208, 209.361 /365 /461 /465, 210, 211.061 /261 /065 /265, 220 ENGINE 112.945 in MODEL 463.209 /232 /233 /244 /245 /250 ENGINE 113 in MODEL 129, ...

AR30.12-P-1321D
Remove/install accelerator pedal
23.9.09
MODEL
124, 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210, 461, 463.200 /204 /206 /207 /208 /209 /220 /221 /224 /225 /227 /228 /230 /231
/232 /233 /240 /241 /300 /304 /307 /308 /320 /321 /324 /325 /327 /328 /330 /331 (except , 461.304 /305 /333 /334
/340 /343 /344 /346)
Diagram left
Models 124, 463, 461

Diagram right
Models 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

P30.10-0220-02

Figure/item, etc.
24/3, 24/1

Work instructions
Expanding clip or expanding wedge pin

P30.10-0221-02

The expanding clip or expanding wedge pin


must engage properly

101

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar30.12-p-1321d, Remove/install accelerator pedal


Page 1 of 1
MODEL 124, 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210, 461, 463.200 /204 /206 /207 /208 /209 /220 /221 /224 /225 /227 /228 /230 /231 /232 /233 /240 /241 /300 /304 /307 /308 /320 /321 /324 /325 /327 /328 /330 ...

AR32.20-P-0300C
MODEL
170, 202, 208

Removing and installing torsion bar on front axle

15.12.93

P32.20-0209-06

ed

Removal, installation

p
1

Replace self-locking bolts and nuts.


Remove bracket (22b).

n Nut (22f)

*BA32.20-P-1001-02C

Remove bracket (21b).

n Nut (21i)

*BA32.20-P-1002-02C

n Nut (21f)

*BA32.20-P-1003-02C

i Installation: Due to the preload of the


bracket (21b), first install the hexagon socket
bolt (21h).
3

Remove spring leaf swivelling lever (21) and p Comply with spring leaf swivelling lever
mounting plate (21c).
assignment!
The spring leaf swivelling lever (21) differs
on the left and right and is mounted
differently depending on the model.

Remove torsion bar (10).

Pull rubber mounts (21a, 22a) off torsion bar


(10).
Install in reverse sequence.

n Bolt (21d)

*BA32.20-P-1004-02C

i Installation: Align torsion bar (10).

n Front axle torsion bar


Number

Designation

BA32.20-P-1001-02C

Self-locking nut for fastening bracket to wishbone

BA32.20-P-1002-02C

Self-locking nut for fastening bracket to top of spring leaf swivelling lever

BA32.20-P-1003-02C

Self-locking nut for fastening bracket to bottom of spring leaf swivelling lever

BA32.20-P-1004-02C

Self-locking bolt for fastening spring leaf swivelling lever to side member

Model 202

Model 208

Nm

20

20

M10

Nm

40

40

M8

Nm

20

20

Nm

60

60

n Front axle torsion bar


Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.20-p-0300c, Removing and installing torsion bar on front axle
MODEL 170, 202, 208

102

Page 1 of 2

Number

Designation

BA32.20-P-1001-02C

Self-locking nut for fastening bracket to wishbone

BA32.20-P-1002-02C

Self-locking nut for fastening bracket to top of spring leaf swivelling lever

BA32.20-P-1003-02C

Self-locking nut for fastening bracket to bottom of spring leaf swivelling lever

BA32.20-P-1004-02C

Self-locking bolt for fastening spring leaf swivelling lever to side member

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.20-p-0300c, Removing and installing torsion bar on front axle
MODEL 170, 202, 208

Model 170

Nm

20

M10

Nm

40

M8

Nm

20

Nm

60

103

Page 2 of 2

AR32.20-P-0230A
Remove/install rear spring
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

7.12.09

P32.20-0206-09

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off of the lifting platform.

i
1
2.1
3
4

Springs; general background information.


Raise vehicle
Remove rear axle switch for roll bar.
Remove track control arm shield (72c).
Remove lateral strut (69).

5.1

Unclip electrical line for brake wear indicator


on spring control arm (72) (arrows).

Insert clamping plates (01b, 01c).

Align vehicle between the columns of the


lifting platform and position the four support
plates at the lifting platform support points
specified by the vehicle manufacturer.
Model 129, 140, 168, 170, 202, 208, 210

AS00.00-Z-0010-01A

Model 129 up to 08/95

ra91001290860x

Model 129 for removal of left rear spring


Model 170, 208.4 for removal of left or right
rear spring
p Installation: n Replace self-locking bolt
(69a, 69b)
Model 129
*BA32.20-P-1001-03A
Model 170
*BA61.10-P-1001-01A
Model 208.4
*BA61.10-P-1003-01C
Vehicles with ASR code 471
p Installation:
Check line is correctly routed.
*202589146300
l Model 140 up to 12.94
l Model 129, 140 as of 01.95, 170, 202,
208, 210
Until the rear axle shaft adopts an almost
horizontal position.

Raise spring control arm (72).

Insert tensioning device (01a).

a Danger!

Risk of injury caused by pinching or


crushing when working on springs or spring
bodies that are under tension

9
10

Clamp rear spring.


Release spring control arm (72).

11

Remove rear spring (73) with rubber bushing m Clean track control arm (72) in area
(74).
surrounding the anchorage point.
Modified front and rear springs
Model 202

AH32.20-P-9404-01A

*202589136300

*202589023100
l
Use only approved tensioning devices; shield AS00.00-Z-0001-01A
off hazard area if necessary.
Inspect special tools for damage and proper
operation (visual inspection).
Wear protective gloves.
AR32.20-P-0200-01A
Model 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210
*BA35.20-P-1001-01A
p Installation: n Replace self-locking nut
(72b) and tighten in almost horizontal
position of rear axle shaft.

BT32.20-P-0001-01A

i After replacing the rear spring or


the rubber mount .
Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.20-p-0230a, Remove/install rear spring
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

104

Page 1 of 3

Check and correct headlamp adjustment


12

AP82.10-P-8260A

Install in the reverse order.

n Rear axle steel suspension


Number

Designation

Model 129

BA32.20-P-1001-03A

Self-locking bolt for fastening cross strut to frame floor


assembly

Nm

120

n Spring control arm


Number

Designation

BA35.20-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut, spring control arm to


rear axle carrier

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Model
129

Model
140

Model
202

Model
208

70

70

70

70

Model
208

Model
210
except 210.07
with Code 979
and Code Z06

70

70

n Spring control arm


Number

Designation

BA35.20-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut, spring control arm to


rear axle carrier

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

n Frame floor assembly


Number

Designation

Model 170

BA61.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking bolt connecting rear cross strut to frame floor

Nm

60

n Frame floor assembly


Number

Designation

BA61.10-P-1003-01C

Self-locking bolt connecting rear cross strut


to frame floor

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.20-p-0230a, Remove/install rear spring


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Model
208.435/445/
447/465/470

Nm

60

105

Page 2 of 3

202 589 02 31 00
Tensioning device

202 589 14 63 00
Tensioning plates

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.20-p-0230a, Remove/install rear spring


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

202 589 13 63 00
Tensioning plates

106

Page 3 of 3

AR32.20-P-0200B
Removing and installing front spring
MODEL
140, 170, 202, 208, 210

27.5.94

P32.25-0221-09

Front spring, models 140

Front spring, model 170, 202, 208, 210

ed

Removing, installing

i
1

General information on springs

Models 129, 140, 168, 170, 202, 208, 210

Detach upper shock absorber fixing and


raise vehicle.

Model 140
p The vehicle must be on its wheels for
removing the upper shock absorber fixing.
i Steady piston rod using Allen wrench

AH32.20-P-9404-01A

Insert clamping plates (01b, 01c)

p Installation: n Replace self-locking nut *BA32.25-P-1001-01A


(11a).
*202589146300
l Model 140
l Models 170, 202, 208, 210

*202589136300

Insert clamping device (01a)

*202589013100

a Danger!

4
5

l Model 210 alternatively


Risk of injury from being trapped or
Only use approved clamping devices and if
crushed when working on preloaded springs appropriate also screen off the danger area.
or spring bodies
Check special tools for damage and
function, (visual inspection). Wear safety
gloves.
Clamp, unclamp front spring
Remove front spring (12) with rubber mount m Clean wishbone in area of support
(13) forwards
surface
i Models 170, 202, 208, 210: additionally
insert plastic support (arrow)
Models 202, 210: insert zinc sealing washer
for England and Scandinavia.

AR32.20-P-0200-01A

Modified front and rear springs

Model 202

BT32.20-P-0001-01A

After replacing the front spring or rubber


mount:
Check and correct headlamp adjustment

AP82.10-P-8260A

*202589023100
AS00.00-Z-0001-01A

Install in reverse order

n Front axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.20-p-0200b, Removing and installing front spring
MODEL 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Model 140

107

Page 1 of 2

BA32.25-P-1001-01A

202 589 01 31 00

Self-locking nut for fastening shock absorber to front


end

202 589 02 31 00

Nm

40

202 589 14 63 00

202 589 13 63 00

Clamping device

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.20-p-0200b, Removing and installing front spring
MODEL 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

108

Page 2 of 2

AR32.25-P-1016A
Remove/install rear suspension strut
MODEL
140 as of 1.6.94,
210
with CODE (217) Level control on rear axle with ADS
with CODE (480) Rear axle level control system
MODEL
202, 203.2, 208 with CODE (480) Rear axle level control system

20.1.09

P32.30-0217-09

Suspension strut, model 140

Suspension strut, model 202, 208,


210.0

Suspension strut, model 210.2, 210.6

P32.30-0263-06

109

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-1016a, Remove/install rear suspension strut


Page 1 of 5
MODEL 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 with CODE (217) Level control on rear axle with ADS with CODE (480) Rear axle level control system MODEL 202, 203.2, 208 with CODE (480) Rear axle level control ...

Suspension strut, model 203.2

P32.25-2044-06

ed

Remove/install

The vehicle must be standing on its wheels


for removing the top suspension strut
mounting.
Remove trunk lining or load area lining
Detach top suspension strut mounting

1
2

Model 140
Counterhold piston rod with Allen wrench
(WAF 5).
l Model 202, 208, 210.0

*202589000900

i Installation: Replace self-locking nut (5a)


on model 140.

3.1
3.2
4
a Danger!

5
p
6.1

6.2

Remove washer (5b) and rubber mount (5c)


Remove washer (5i) and rubber mount (5c)
Raise vehicle
Risk of injury to skin or eyes caused by
hydraulic fluid spraying out under high
pressure. Risk of poisoning caused by
swallowing hydraulic fluid
Empty pressurized oil system
General information for working on vehicles
with level control/ADS
Disconnect pressure line (P4) at connection
of the steel line/pressure hose

Disconnect pressure line (P4) at suspension


strut

n Model 140 nut (5a)

*BA32.30-P-1001-01A

n Model 202, 203, 208 nut (5p)

*BA32.30-P-1001-01B

n Model 210.0 nut (5p)

*BA32.30-P-1006-01A

n Models 202, 208 nut (5a)

*BA32.30-P-1002-01B

n Model 210.0 nut (5a)

*BA32.30-P-1005-01A

n Model 210.2, 210.6 bolt (5g)


Model 202, 203, 208, 210.0
Model 210.2, 210.6

*BA32.30-P-1007-01A

Depressurize the hydraulic system


completely before starting any work on the
system. Wear protective clothing and safety
glasses.

AS00.00-Z-0013-01A

i Installation: Fill pressurized oil system


All models with code 216b, 216c, 217a, 480
Model 140, 210.2, 210.6
i Installation: Pay attention to correct
routing of pressure line (P4).
n Model 140

*BA32.30-P-1003-01A

n Model 210.2, 210.6


Model 202, 203, 208, 210.0

*BA32.30-P-1003-01A

n Model 202, 208

*BA32.30-P-1004-01B

n Model 210.0

*BA32.30-P-1004-01B

i Installation: Replace copper sealing


rings on banjo bolt (5v)
Before tightening the pressure line on
suspension strut
Check/set up distance between the
suspension strut and wheel arch
7

AR32.30-P-0630A
AH32.00-P-0002-01A

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

Detach cover of spring control arm (72c)


110

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-1016a, Remove/install rear suspension strut


Page 2 of 5
MODEL 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 with CODE (217) Level control on rear axle with ADS with CODE (480) Rear axle level control system MODEL 202, 203.2, 208 with CODE (480) Rear axle level control ...

Detach/remove suspension strut (5) on


spring control arm (72)

iInstallation: Pull suspension strut apart


so that the suspension strut mount abuts the
dome.
Model 140: The sheet metal plate on the
suspension strut mount must point in the
direction of travel.
Replace self-locking nut (5n).
n Model 140
Model 202, 203, 208
n Model 210

g
9

*BA32.30-P-1003-01B
*BA32.30-P-1002-01A

Checking

10

Check rubber mounts (5c, 5d), plate (5e)


suspension strut mount and rubber boot for
damage and cracks.
Check ball joint for wear
Check suspension strut for leaktightness

11

Install in the reverse order

a Danger!

Risk of injury caused by drilling gas-filled


assemblies or components (noncombustible
gases)
Dispose of suspension strut

12

*BA32.30-P-1002-01A

i A slight oil mist is permissible.


If the joint eye is wet with oil
replace
suspension strut.
i After installing: Check distance
between suspension strut and wheel arch in
the ready to drive condition
Model 202, 203, 208, 210.0: If necessary,
AR32.30-P-0610-01A
loosen top suspension strut mounting and realign suspension strut.
Wear safety glasses and a face mask.
AS00.00-Z-0006-01A

OS32.25-P-0120-01A

Check values for rear axle suspension strut


Number

Designation

BE32.30-P-1001-01A

Distance between
bracket of pressure
hose on suspension
strut tube and wheel
arch

at full rebound
travel

Distance between the


ready to drive
bracket of the pressure (vehicle standing
hose on suspension
on its wheels)
strut tube and wheel
arch

Model 203.2
with level
control

Left

mm

11-15

11 to 15

Right

mm

24-28

24 to 28

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

See picture
BE32.30-P-1002-01A

Model 202 with


level control

LEFT

mm

14-18

14 to 18

Right

mm

26-30

26 to 30

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

Model 208 with


level control

Model 210.0
with level
control/ADS

See picture

Check values for rear axle suspension strut


Number

Designation

BE32.30-P-1001-01A

Distance between the


at full rebound
bracket of the pressure travel
hose on suspension
strut tube and wheel
arch

Left

mm

11-15

8,5-10,5

Right

mm

24-28

8,5-10,5
111

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-1016a, Remove/install rear suspension strut


Page 3 of 5
MODEL 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 with CODE (217) Level control on rear axle with ADS with CODE (480) Rear axle level control system MODEL 202, 203.2, 208 with CODE (480) Rear axle level control ...

See picture
BE32.30-P-1002-01A

Distance between the


ready to drive
bracket of the pressure (vehicle standing
hose on suspension
on its wheels)
strut tube and wheel
arch

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

LEFT

mm

14-18

10.5-12,5

Right

mm

26-30

10.5-12,5

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

AR32.30-P-0610-01A

Model 202 with


level control

Model 203.2
with level
control

See picture

n Suspension strut rear axle


Number

Designation

BA32.30-P-1001-01B

Nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Nm

18

18

BA32.30-P-1002-01B

Jam nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Nm

30

30

BA32.30-P-1003-01B

Self-locking nut, ride-height control strut


to track control arm

Nm

55

55

BA32.30-P-1004-01B

Banjo bolt of pressure line of level control on


suspension strut

Nm

25

25

n Suspension strut rear axle


Number

Designation

Model 208 with


level control

BA32.30-P-1001-01B

Nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Nm

18

BA32.30-P-1002-01B

Jam nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Nm

30

BA32.30-P-1003-01B

Self-locking nut, ride-height control strut


to track control arm

Nm

55

BA32.30-P-1004-01B

Banjo bolt of pressure line of level control on


suspension strut

Nm

25

n Suspension strut rear axle


Number

Designation

BA32.30-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut, suspension strut level control/ADS to


frame floor

Nm

Model 140 with


level control/
ADS

Model 210.0
with level
control/ADS

40

112

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-1016a, Remove/install rear suspension strut


Page 4 of 5
MODEL 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 with CODE (217) Level control on rear axle with ADS with CODE (480) Rear axle level control system MODEL 202, 203.2, 208 with CODE (480) Rear axle level control ...

BA32.30-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut, suspension strut level control/ADS to


spring control arm

BA32.30-P-1003-01A

Pressure line level control to steel pipe connection


suspension strut - pressure hose (reference figure)

BA32.30-P-1004-01A

Nm

100

55

Nm

30

30

Banjo bolt of pressure line of level control to suspension


strut

Nm

25

BA32.30-P-1005-01A

Jam nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Nm

30

BA32.30-P-1006-01A

Nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Nm

17

BA32.30-P-1007-01A

Nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Nm

M16 1.5

n Suspension strut rear axle


Number

Designation

BA32.30-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut, suspension strut level control/ADS to


spring control arm

BA32.30-P-1003-01A

Pressure line level control to steel pipe connection


suspension strut - pressure hose (reference figure)

BA32.30-P-1007-01A

Nut, suspension strut of level control to frame floor


assembly

Model 210.2
with level
control/ADS

M16 1.5

Nm

55

Nm

30

Nm

25

202 589 00 09 00
Socket wrench

113

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-1016a, Remove/install rear suspension strut


Page 5 of 5
MODEL 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 with CODE (217) Level control on rear axle with ADS with CODE (480) Rear axle level control system MODEL 202, 203.2, 208 with CODE (480) Rear axle level control ...

AR32.25-P-0105A
Remove/install front shock absorber
MODEL
140, 170, 202, 208, 210

12.9.11

P32.25-0203-09

Damper, model 140

Damper, model 170, 202, 208, 210

ed

Remove/install

The vehicle must be on its wheels for the


removal of the upper shock absorber mount.
Detach upper shock absorber mount.
Model 140
Counterhold piston rod using Allen wrench
(size 5).

iModel 170, 202, 208, 210: Remove cap


(11e)
l Model 170, 202, 208, 210

*202589000900

pInstallation: Replace self-locking nut (11


a).

2.1
3
4

n Model 140 nut (11a)

*BA32.25-P-1001-01A

n Model 170, 202, 208, 210 nut (11p)

*BA32.25-P-1001-01B

n Model 170, 202, 208, 210 nut (11a)


Remove plate (11b) and rubber mount (11c). Model 170, 202, 208, 210
Raise vehicle.
Detach damper (11) from transverse control p Installation:
arm (31) and remove downwards.
Replace self-locking nut (11u).

*BA32.25-P-1002-01B

Remove attaching parts (11y, 11d, 11f, 11h)


of damper (11).

6
7

Check shock absorber.


Install in the reverse order.

n Model 140

*BA32.25-P-1002-01A

n Model 170, 202, 208, 210


Model 170, 202, 208, 210
g Check attaching parts (11d, 11f, 11h) for
damage and cracks.

*BA32.25-P-1003-01B

AR32.25-P-0121A

n Front axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

BA32.25-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut for attaching damper on front end

Nm

40

BA32.25-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut for attaching damper on transverse


control arm

Nm

100

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-0105a, Remove/install front shock absorber


MODEL 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

Model 140

114

Page 1 of 2

n Front axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

BA32.25-P-1001-01B

Nut for shock absorber on front end

BA32.25-P-1002-01B

Lock nut for shock absorber on front end

BA32.25-P-1003-01B

Self-locking nut, shock absorber to wishbone

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

Nm

18

18

18

Nm

30

30

30

Nm

55

55

55

Yellow

Nm

silver/blue

Nm

n Front axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

Model 210
except 210.07
with
codes Z04, Z06
210.08/28

BA32.25-P-1001-01B

Nut for shock absorber on front end

Nm

18

BA32.25-P-1002-01B

Lock nut for shock absorber on front end

Nm

30

BA32.25-P-1003-01B

Self-locking nut, shock absorber to wishbone

Nm

55

Yellow

Nm

silver/blue

Nm

202 589 00 09 00
Socket wrench

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-0105a, Remove/install front shock absorber


MODEL 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

115

Page 2 of 2

AR32.25-P-0110A
Remove/install rear shock absorber
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 203, 208
MODEL
209 except CODE (P98) Black Series
MODEL
210 except CODE (489) All-round level control system

12.9.11

Shock absorber model 129, 170, 202, 203


208, 209 and model 210 with steel
suspension

P32.25-2082-06

Shock absorber model 140 and model


210 with ADS (Adaptive Damper System)

P32.25-2083-06

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off of the lifting platform.

p
1

Notes on self-locking nuts and bolts


Detach upper shock absorber mount

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift AS00.00-Z-0010-01A


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
AH00.00-N-0001-01A
i The vehicle must be on its wheels for
removing the upper shock absorber mount.
i Vehicles with steel suspension:
l Models 170, 202, 208, 210

*202589000900

n Models 129, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, nut *BA32.25-P-1001-03A


(75p)
Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-0110a, Remove/install rear shock absorber
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 203, 208 MODEL 209 except CODE (P98) Black Series MODEL 210 except CODE (489) All-round level control system

116

Page 1 of 3

n Models 129, 170, 202, 208 nut (75a)

*BA32.25-P-1002-03A

n Model 210 nut (75a)

*BA32.25-P-1003-03B

i Vehicles with ADS (Adaptive Damper


System):
i The vehicle must be on its wheels for
removing the upper shock absorber mount.
Model 140, 210 with ADS (Adaptive Damper
System)
Counterhold piston rod with Allen wrench
(SW5).
2

Remove plate (75b) and rubber mount (75c)

3
4
5
6

Raise vehicle
Remove rear axle switch for roll bar
Remove track control arm shield (72c).
Detach shock absorber (75) from spring
control arm

Remove mounting parts (75k, 75d, 75f, 75i)


for shock absorber (75)

*BA32.25-P-1001-03B
n Model 140, 210 nut (75e)
Model 129, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209, 210 with
steel suspension
Model 129 up to 08/95

ra91001290860x

n Models 129, 170, 202, 203, 208, 209

*BA32.25-P-1003-03A

n Model 140, 210


Model 129, 170, 202, 208, 210

*BA32.25-P-1002-03B

g Check mounting parts (75d, 75f, 75i) for


damage and cracks.
8
9

Check shock absorber


Install in the reverse order

AR32.25-P-0121A

n Rear axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

BA32.25-P-1001-03A

Nut for attaching shock absorber to frame floor

BA32.25-P-1002-03A

Jam nut for attaching shock absorber to frame


floor assembly

BA32.25-P-1003-03A

Self-locking nut for attaching shock absorber to


spring control arm

Model 129

Model 170

Model 202

Nm

18

18

18

M10

Nm

Nm

30

30

30

Stage 1

Nm

55

55

55

Stage 2

Nm

Model 203

Model 208

Model
209
without
code P98

M10

n Rear axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

BA32.25-P-1001-03A

Nut for attaching shock absorber to frame floor

BA32.25-P-1002-03A

Jam nut for attaching shock absorber to frame


floor assembly

BA32.25-P-1003-03A

Self-locking nut for attaching shock absorber to


spring control arm

Nm

30

18

20

M10

Nm

Nm

30

Stage 1

Nm

55

55

50

Stage 2

Nm

M10

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-0110a, Remove/install rear shock absorber


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 203, 208 MODEL 209 except CODE (P98) Black Series MODEL 210 except CODE (489) All-round level control system

117

Page 2 of 3

n Rear axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

Model 140

Model 210

BA32.25-P-1001-03B

Self-locking nut for attaching shock absorber to frame


floor

Nm

40

BA32.25-P-1002-03B

Self-locking nut for attaching shock absorber to spring


control arm

Nm

100

55

BA32.25-P-1003-03B

Lock nut, shock absorber to frame floor

Nm

30

202 589 00 09 00
Socket wrench

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar32.25-p-0110a, Remove/install rear shock absorber


MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 203, 208 MODEL 209 except CODE (P98) Black Series MODEL 210 except CODE (489) All-round level control system

118

Page 3 of 3

AR35.10-P-0010D
MODEL
170, 202, 208

Remove/install complete rear axle

12.9.11

P35.10-0264-06

P35.10-2246-09

Modification notes
20.3.04

20.3.04

Oil filler/drain screw on rear axle differential modified

The oil filler screw should always be replaced after being


unscrewed from the rear axle differential.
The new oil filler screw as well as the tapped hole must
be cleaned with a special cleaning spray and the oil filler
screw provided with a special sealing compound
The vehicle must have a chassis alignment check after
the rear axle is installed

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Phased in as of 19.01.04
BT35.31-P-0015-01A
i The oil filler screws and oil drain screws
should always be replaced after being
unscrewed.
The new oil filler screws and drain screws
as well as the tapped holes must be cleaned
with a special cleaning spray and provided
with a special sealing compound.
AR35.31-P-0520-03A
i Only carry out oil level check at interior
temperature.

119

Page 1 of 8

Fig. item etc.


a Danger!

Work instructions
Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or
toppling off of the lifting platform.

Notes on self-locking nuts and bolts

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift AS00.00-Z-0010-01A


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
AH00.00-N-0001-01A

i Installation

Bleed ASD hydraulic system

Model Series 202 with ASD up to 05/94

i Installation

Check vehicle level at rear axle

i Installation

Check oil level in rear axle differential and


correct if necessary

k
i Installation
i Installation

Oil filler/drain screw on rear axle differential


modified
Perform wheel alignment check

AR35.41-P-0519C
AR40.20-P-0300A

i Mixing of old universal hypoid gear oil


and the new FE hypoid gear oil should be
avoided due to the better fuel economy.

AR35.31-P-0520-03A

j Model 170

*BF35.31-P-1001-01F

j Model 202

*BF35.31-P-1001-01D

j Model 208
Loctite 7063 cleaning spray (150 ml)
Sealant, Omnifit 100H (50 g)

*BF35.31-P-1001-01H

n Oil filler plug


Phased in as of 19.01.04

*BR00.45-Z-1046-04A
*BR00.45-Z-1061-01A
*BA35.31-P-1002-02A
BT35.31-P-0015-01A
AR40.20-P-0200A

Check headlamp adjustment and correct if


necessary
Check and correct headlamp adjustment

AP82.10-P-8260A

Assembly attachment

*140589016200

l
1c

Guard plate

*220589013100

Front rear rear-axle suspension bolt

p Installation: Recut thread on frame floor


with tap.
n

1d

6g
6i
a Danger!

6j

Rear rear-axle suspension bolt

Spring control arm covering


Remove/install rear spring
Risk of injury to skin or eyes caused by
hydraulic fluid spraying out under high
pressure. Risk of poisoning caused by
swallowing hydraulic fluid
Detach dampers or suspension struts from
the spring control arms

*BA35.10-P-1001-01A

p Installation: Recut thread on frame floor


with tap.
n

*BA35.10-P-1002-01A

Remove both rear springs.


Depressurize the hydraulic system
completely before starting any work on the
system. Wear protective clothing and safety
glasses.

AR32.20-P-0230A
AS00.00-Z-0013-01A

n Vehicles without ride-height control.

*BA32.25-P-1003-03A

n Vehicles with ride-height control.

*BA32.30-P-1003-01B

6k

Stabilizer bar link rod

*BA32.20-P-1002-04C

36

Detach both frame cross struts

n Model 170 only

*BA61.10-P-1001-01A

105

105c
106

n Model 208.4 only


Remove / install exhaust system from flange Refer to: Remove/install exhaust system
connection
complete:
Model 170 with engines 111.943/946/973
Model Series 170 with Engine 111.958/983
Model 170 with engine 112
Model 202 with engine 104, 111
Model 202 with engine 601
Model 202 with engine 604, 605
Model 202 with engine 611
Model 202, 208 with engine 112, 113
Model 208 with engine 111
Exhaust shielding plate
Remove rear of driveshaft at joint flange
i Flex disk remains on propeller shaft.
Loosen fitting sleeves on flexible couplings.
Drift for loosening fitting sleeves in flex
disks.

*BA61.10-P-1003-01C

AR49.10-P-7000G
AR49.10-P-7000GS
AR49.10-P-7000SV
AR49.10-P-7000D
ra49006010100x
AR49.10-P-7000I
AR49.10-P-7000HB
AR49.10-P-7000AU
AR49.10-P-7000DA

AR41.10-P-0050-09DA
WF58.50-P-4110-01A

i Fit on propeller shaft at stiffener arm.


n
106 A

Propeller shaft center support bearing

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle


MODEL 170, 202, 208

*BA41.10-P-1002-01A

i Installation: Only tighten the bolts of the


propeller shaft intermediate bearing after
attaching the flexible coupling to the rear
axle differential.
120

Page 2 of 8

106c

Propeller shaft clamp nut

Clamp connection of propeller shaft

110b

Parking brake cables from automatic cable


adjuster or idler lever, releasing and
attaching

a Danger!

111e

n
Model 202 up to approx. 10/95

*BA41.40-P-1001-01A

l Open-end wrench 46 mm

*126589000100

l Open-end wrench 41 mm

*201589000100

n
Model 202:
Converted to flexible connection.
See:

*BA41.10-P-1003-01A
BT41.10-P-9110-01DA

Remove/install rear brake control cable


Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake appropriately marked containers. Wear
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes. protective clothing and eye protection when
handling brake fluid.
Brake hose
Detach brake hose from floorpan.

AR42.20-P-0525A
AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

p Seal line connections immediately with


plugs. The brake fluid reservoir must not run
completely empty.
l Box-end wrench attachment

*000589750300

p Installation: The brake hoses (111e)


must not be twisted after being tightened
(danger of cracking).
n

*BA42.10-P-1001-04A

p Installation: Bleed brake system

AR42.10-P-0010A

Brake fluid notes

AH42.50-P-0001-01A

Notes on installing brake hoses

AH42.10-P-9406-01A

i
115

Notes on repairs to brake system

AH42.00-P-0003-01A

140
a

HS

L6
L6/3, L6/4

X33/17
X33/17
X62/1, X62/2
X62/11

Remove fuel pump assembly from rubber


rings and tie into place with wire
Shield on fuel pump assembly
Disconnect, connect 2-pin fuel pump wiring
harness connector
Hydraulic line

Engine 104, 111


Only Model 202 to 05/94 with ASD

AR47.20-P-5713D

Rear axle rpm sensor

i Removal: Plug threaded sockets on ring


cylinder and line.
Vehicles with ABS:

i Clean magnetic tip, replace O-ring.


Remove/install left rear rpm sensor and right Vehicles with ASR up to 05/94
rear rpm sensor
Vehicles with ASR, ETS, ESP as of 06/94
Rear headlamp range adjustment connector Model 170: Vehicles with Xenon headlamps
Rear ADS/headlamp range adjustment
Models 202, 208: Vehicles with Xenon
connector
headlamps
Left rear rpm sensor / brake wear indicator
i If installed
connector
Rear axle ABS rpm sensor connector (2-pin) i If installed

ra42001240714x
ra42002020820x
AR42.40-P-0820A

n Rear axle stabilizer bar


Number

Designation

BA32.20-P-1002-04C

Self-locking nut, linkage rod to track control arm

Nm

Model 170

Model 202
without
level
adjustmen
t

Model 202
with
level
control

20

20

20

Model 208
without
level
control

Model 208
with
level
control

n Rear axle stabilizer bar


Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle


MODEL 170, 202, 208

121

Page 3 of 8

BA32.20-P-1002-04C

Self-locking nut, linkage rod to track control arm

Nm

20

20

n Suspension strut rear axle


Number

Designation

BA32.30-P-1003-01B

Self-locking nut, ride-height control strut


to track control arm

Nm

Model 202 with


level control

Model 208 with


level control

55

55

n Rear axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

BA32.25-P-1003-03A

Self-locking nut for attaching shock absorber to


spring control arm

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

55

55

55

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Nm

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

M10

n Rear axle carrier


Number

Designation

BA35.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking bolt, front rear axle


carrier rubber mount to frame floor

BA35.10-P-1002-01A

Self-locking bolt, rear axle carrier


rear rubber mount to frame floor

Nm

90

90

90

with bolt Flange Stage 1


24 mm

Nm

Stage 2

with bolt flange Stage 1


26 mm

Nm

Stage 2

Nm

90

90

90

with bolt Flange Stage 1


24 mm

Nm

Stage 2

with bolt flange Stage 1


26 mm

Nm

Stage 2

n Differential housing

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle


MODEL 170, 202, 208

122

Page 4 of 8

Number

Designation

BA35.31-P-1002-02A

Oil filler screw, differential

Nm

Model
170

Model
202

50

50

n Differential housing
Number

Designation

BA35.31-P-1002-02A

Oil filler screw, differential

Model
208

Nm

50

n Propeller shaft
Number

Designation

BA41.10-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut, flexible coupling to rear propeller


shaft or rear axle differential.

BA41.10-P-1003-01A

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

M10

Nm

40

40

40

M12

Nm

60

60

60

Nm

40

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

Clamping nut of propellor shaft

n Propeller shaft center support bearing


Number

Designation

BA41.40-P-1001-01A

Bolt, propeller shaft center


support bearing to frame floor
assembly

Self-tapping screw

Nm

Bolt with washer

Nm

25

25

25

Bolt with collar and selfcentering tip

Nm

30

30

30

Bolt with collar and


without self-centering tip

Nm

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

14

14

14

n Brake lines, brake hoses


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1001-04A

Brake pipe to brake hose

n Frame floor assembly


Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle
MODEL 170, 202, 208

Nm

123

Page 5 of 8

Number

Designation

Model 170

BA61.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking bolt connecting rear cross strut to frame floor

Nm

60

n Frame floor assembly


Number

Designation

BA61.10-P-1003-01C

Self-locking bolt connecting rear cross strut


to frame floor

Model
208.435/445/
447/465/470

Nm

60

j Differential
Number

Designation

BF35.31-P-1001-01D

Filling
capacity

Differential

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

Sheet

Model
202.018/020/
022/120/121/125,
with (code 211)
ASD

Model
202.018/078/
120/121/122/
125/182 except
(code 450) taxi
version,
model
202.018/120/
121/125 without
(code 211) ASD,
model 202.180

Model
202.018/078/
120/121/122/
125/182,
without (code
211) ASD, with
(code 450) taxi
version

1.1

0.7

1.1

BB00.40-P-0235-00A

BB00.40-P-0235-00A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

Model
202.020/022/
023/024/025/
026/028/029/
080/081/082/
083/086/087/
088/089/128/
188 without
(code 211) ASD,
model 202.085
with automatic
5-speed
transmission,
model
202.134/194
except (code
450)
taxi version

Model
202.033/093/
133/193
Model 202.085
with manual 5speed
transmission,
Model
202.134/194
with (Code 450)
Taxi version

j Differential
Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle


MODEL 170, 202, 208

124

Page 6 of 8

BF35.31-P-1001-01D

Filling
capacity

Differential

Liters

1.1

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0235-00A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

Model 170.435

Model
170.444/445/447/
449

Model
170.465/466

1.1

j Differential
Number

Designation

BF35.31-P-1001-01F

Filling
capacity

Differential

Liters

0.7

1.1

1.1

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

j Differential
Number

Designation

BF35.31-P-1001-01H

Filling
capacity

126 589 00 01 00
Open end wrench

Model
Model
208.335/344/345/ 208.365/
347/348/435/444/ 370/465/470
445/447/448

Model
208.374/474

Differential

Liters

1.1

1.1

1.6

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

BB00.40-P-0235-07A

201 589 00 01 00
Open end wrench

140 589 01 62 00

220 589 01 31 00

Assembly attachment

Guard plate

000 589 75 03 00
Box wrench bit

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1061-01A

Designation
Sealant, Omnifit 100H (50 g)

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Order number
A 002 989 23 71

125

Page 7 of 8

BR00.45-Z-1046-04A

Loctite 7063 cleaning spray (150 ml)

Daimler AG, 8/2/15, G/04/14, ar35.10-p-0010d, Remove/install complete rear axle


MODEL 170, 202, 208

A 001 986 71 71 10

126

Page 8 of 8

AR41.10-P-0050EA
MODEL
170, 202, 208
1
2
3
4
7
7a
20
21
21a
26
27
27a
105c
105d

Remove/install propeller shaft

17.12.09

Front propeller shaft


Rear propeller shaft
Propeller shaft clamp nut
Rubber boot
Propeller shaft intermediate bearing
Screw
Vibration damper
Crossmember
Bolts
Nut
Reinforcement brace
Screw
Exhaust shielding plate on tunnel
Sheet metal nut

P41.10-0207-06

Modification notes
18.6.97

Replacement part change: Front propeller shaft hole


circle diameter changed

ed

Remove/install

p Installation
1
2
3

Replace self-locking nuts and bolts.

4
5
6
7
8

Step 16

Remove bottom section of soundproofing


Remove left rear frame cross brace
Remove exhaust system starting as of
connector
Unhook suspension rubbers of exhaust
system

Model 170, 202.1, 208


i Support exhaust system at rear muffler.

Detach exhaust shielding plate (105c) in


tunnel area
Detach rear cross bridge (21)

n Model 202, 208

Detach reinforcement brace (27)


Loosen propeller shaft clamp nut (3)

Clamp connection of propeller shaft

Loosen bolts (7a) of propeller shaft center


support bearing

10
11

Remove rear engine mount


Detach front propeller shaft from
transmission

Model 202.1
Model 170, 208.4
Model 202.0

*BA61.10-P-1001-01C

n Model 170

*BA61.10-P-1004-01A

n Model 202, 208

*BA61.10-P-1002-01C

n Model 170
Model 202 up to approx. 10/95
iLoosen clamp nut approx. one revolution,
do not side back the rubber boot (the rubber
boot slides at the same time).

*BA61.10-P-1003-01A

l Models 202.01/020/022/1

*201589000100

l Model 202.028

*126589000100

*BA41.10-P-1003-01A
n
i Installation:Tighten propeller shaft clamp
nut, pay attention to correct seat of rubber
boot.
Observe technical modifications
Converted to flexible connection.
BT41.10-P-9110-01DA
i Tighten bolts (7a) only after fastening the
flex disks to the transmission and rear axle
center assembly.
n
Model 170, 208, with AT.

*BA41.40-P-1001-01A
AR22.10-P-1160HB

i Flexible disk remains on propeller shaft.


n
Observe technical modifications

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar41.10-p-0050ea, Remove/install propeller shaft


MODEL 170, 202, 208

*BA61.10-P-1001-01A

*BA41.10-P-1001-01A

127

Page 1 of 4

k
12

Vibration damper discontinued at the front


propeller shaft
Remove propeller shaft from rear axle
center assembly.

Model 202.018/020 with automatic


transmission (722.422).
i The flexible coupling remains on the
propeller shaft.
n

13

y
14
15

Release fitting sleeves on flex disks


Drift for releasing the fitting sleeves in the
flexible couplings
Remove bolts (7a) of propeller shaft center
support bearing
Pull off propeller shaft from centering spigot
on transmission and rear axle and take out
backwards

16

Separate front and rear propeller shaft if


necessary

g
17

Checking
Check flexible couplings, centering sleeves
and propeller shaft center support bearing
for wear

*BA41.10-P-1002-01A
AR41.10-P-0050-09DA
WF58.50-P-4110-01A

i Support propeller shaft.


j
i Installation: Coat splined shaft profile
with MB long-term grease

*BF41.10-P-1001-01A

i Installation: Coat splined profile with MB- *BR00.45-Z-1001-06A


long-life grease
Specifications for Operating Fluids sheet
266.2
Connect sections of propeller shaft.
AR41.10-P-0050-05DA
ra27147220440x
i Installation: On model 202.121 with 4speed automatic transmission 722.4 except
with code 450 Taxi-version (up to 31.7.96)
for logistical reasons for the replacement
part requirement only a front propeller shaft
hole circle- 90mm (formerly 80mm) is
available. The three arm flange on the
transmission should therefore be replaced at
the same time
Replace if necessary

Remove/install propeller shaft intermediate


bearing and replacing deep-groove ball
bearing.
Replace centering sleeve.
18

BT41.10-P-0002-01A

AR41.10-P-0100DA

AR41.10-P-0200DA

Install in the reverse order.

n Propeller shaft
Number

Designation

BA41.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut, flexible coupling to transmission


or front propeller shaft

BA41.10-P-1002-01A

BA41.10-P-1003-01A

Self-locking nut, flexible coupling to rear propeller


shaft or rear axle differential.

Model
170

Model
208

M10

Nm

40

40

M12

Nm

60

60

M10

Nm

40

40

M12

Nm

60

60

Nm

Clamping nut of propellor shaft

n Propeller shaft
Number

Designation

BA41.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking nut, flexible coupling to transmission


or front propeller shaft

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar41.10-p-0050ea, Remove/install propeller shaft


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Model
202

M10

Nm

40

M12

Nm

60

128

Page 2 of 4

BA41.10-P-1002-01A

BA41.10-P-1003-01A

Self-locking nut, flexible coupling to rear propeller


shaft or rear axle differential.

M10

Nm

40

M12

Nm

60

Nm

40

Clamping nut of propellor shaft

n Propeller shaft intermediate bearing


Number

Designation

BA41.40-P-1001-01A

Bolt, propeller shaft


intermediate bearing to frame
floor assembly

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

Self-tapping screw

Nm

Bolt with washer

Nm

25

25

25

Bolt with collar and selfcentering tip

Nm

30

30

30

Bolt with collar and


without self-centering tip

Nm

n Frame floor assembly


Number

Designation

Model
202

Model
208.335/345/
347/365/370/374

Model
208.435/445/
447/465/470

BA61.10-P-1001-01C

Self-locking bolt connecting rear transverse


bridge to frame floor

Nm

40

40

40

BA61.10-P-1002-01C

Self-locking bolt connecting reinforcement


brace to front of frame floor

Nm

25

25

25

BA61.10-P-1003-01C

Self-locking bolt connecting rear cross strut


to frame floor

Nm

60

n Frame floor assembly


Number

Designation

Model 170

BA61.10-P-1001-01A

Self-locking bolt connecting rear cross strut to frame floor

Nm

60

BA61.10-P-1003-01A

Bolt, front stiffening bridge to frame floor assembly

Nm

20

BA61.10-P-1004-01A

Bolt, rear cross bridge to frame floor assembly

Nm

20

j Propeller shaft
Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar41.10-p-0050ea, Remove/install propeller shaft


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Model 202

Model 170

Model 208

129

Page 3 of 4

BF41.10-P-1001-01A

Grease
quantity

Centering sleeve of propeller


shaft
Specifications for Operating
Fluids

126 589 00 01 00

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0267-00A

BB00.40-P-0267-00A

BB00.40-P-0267-00A

201 589 00 01 00

Open end wrench

Open end wrench

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1001-06A

Designation
Long-life grease

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar41.10-p-0050ea, Remove/install propeller shaft


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Order number
A 000 989 63 51 11

130

Page 4 of 4

AR41.10-P-0100DA
MODEL

Removal and installation of propeller shaft intermediate bearing and


replacement of grooved ball bearing
129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

29.7.94

Front propeller shaft with clamp


connection
1a Front propeller shaft with slide
connection
2
Rear propeller shaft
3
Propeller shaft clamping nut
4/4a Rubber boot (optional)
6
Front protective cap (shaft side)
6a Rear protective cap (fork side)
7
Rubber mount, models 129, 140, 202
and 208
7a Rubber mount, model 210
8
Grooved ball bearing

P41.40-0201-06

ed
1

Removal, installation
Remove propeller shaft

Model 129
Model 140
Model 202, 170, 208
Model 210

Separate front (1, 1a) and rear propeller


shaft (2) at clamp connection or slide
connection

i Installation: Assemble propeller shaft.

AR41.10-P-0050A
AR41.10-P-0050DA
AR41.10-P-0050EA
AR41.10-P-0050B
AR41.10-P-0050-05DA

k
k

Clamp connection of propeller shaft

Observe Technical modification


Model 129.066, 140.04/050/051

BT41.10-P-9110-01DA

Universal joint on rear propeller shaft

Model 140.050/051

BT41.10-P-9111-02DA

Pull rubber boot (4, 4a) off joint fork

iInstallation: Replace damaged rubber


boot and ensure correct fit.

Pull off rubber mount (7, 7a) with grooved


ball bearing (8) and front protective cap (6)

AR41.10-P-0100-01DA

i Installation: Press rubber mount with


grooved ball bearing onto the joint fork.
Fit new protective cap on grooved ball
bearing.
Models 129, 140 and 202 as of 6/95 are no
longer fitted with a protective cap.
Models 170, 208, 210 are no protective cap
Observe Technical modification
Models 129.066/067/076, 140.04/05/07/13

AR41.10-P-0100-05DA
AR41.10-P-0100-04DA

Propeller shaft intermediate bearing

Remove rear protective cap (6a)

iInstallation: Replace protective cap if


damaged.

Press grooved ball bearing out of rubber


mount

l Models 129, 140,170.445/447,


202.024/025/026/028/029/082/085/086/
089/128/133/188/193,
208.345/347/365/370/445/447/465/470,
210.006/015/017/020/025/045/053/055/
06/07,
210.08/206/215/217/225/245/26/27/28/
606/617/663

*116589094300

l Models 170.435,
202.01/020/022/023/078/080/083,
202.120/121/122/125/180/182,
208.335/435,
210.003/004/010/035/037/210/235/237,
210.610

*201589094300

i Installation: Press grooved ball bearing


into rubber mount.

AR41.10-P-0100-02DA

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar41.10-p-0100da, Removal and installation of propeller shaft intermediate bearing and replacement of grooved ball bearing
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

BT41.10-P-9208-01DA

131

Page 1 of 2

Check rubber mount and grooved ball


bearing for wear
Install in reverse sequence.

126 589 03 15 00
Alignment tool

201 589 09 43 00
Press-out/in device

000 589 88 33 00
Puller

Replace parts if necessary.

129 589 00 34 00
Puller arms

116 589 09 43 00
Press-out/in device

201 589 07 15 00
Alignment tool

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar41.10-p-0100da, Removal and installation of propeller shaft intermediate bearing and replacement of grooved ball bearing
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

132

Page 2 of 2

AP42.00-P-4280BA
Replace brake fluid
MODEL
140 as of 1.7.93,
202 up to 31.5.94,
210, 170, 208 (except , 208.474) except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR)
MODEL
202, 210, 215 (except , 210.072 /272) with CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)
MODEL
220
with CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP)
except CODE (Z07) Top protection
10
11

2.11.11

Brake fluid reservoir


Cap

P42.00-0202-01

Picture item, etc.


a Danger!

a Danger!

p
p
1
2
3
4

f
f

Work instructions
Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or
toppling off of the lifting platform.

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift AS00.00-Z-0010-01A


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
AS42.50-Z-0001-01A
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake appropriately marked containers. Wear
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes. protective clothing and eye protection when
handling brake fluid.
Notes on repairs to brake system
AH42.00-P-0003-01A
Brake fluid notes

AH42.50-P-0001-01A

Drive vehicle over the assembly pit and raise


using the lifting platform
Open screw cap (11) of reservoir for brake
fluid (10)
Extract brake fluid from brake fluid reservoir
(10)
Pour in new brake fluid
i Up to the "MAX" mark on the reservoir
for brake fluid (10).
Replacing brake fluid with the brake fluid
changing equipment
Connect brake fluid changing equipment and i Pay attention to manufacturer's operating
switch on
instructions.
Brake fluid change unit
gotis://B_42/43.2_01
Drain brake fluid
i The new brake fluid must escape via the
bleed hose free of bubbles. Allow approx. 80
cm3 of brake fluid to flow out at each brake
caliper and at the clutch slave cylinder.
Carrying out bleeding operation
Model 220, 215
AR42.10-P-0010-02I
Carrying out bleeding operation

Model 140, 170, 208, 210 except code 471


AR42.10-P-0010-02A
Acceleration slip regulation (ASR)
Model 202 up to 31.5.94 except code 471
Acceleration slip regulation (ASR)
Model 210 except code 472 Electronic
Stability Program (ESP)
Model 140, 202, 210 with code 472 Electronic
Stability Program (ESP)
Front axle model 140:
*BA42.10-P-1002-10I
n Bleed screw to brake caliper
Front axle model 170:
n Bleed screw to brake caliper
Front axle model 202:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10P

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 208:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10K

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 210:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10D

n Bleed screw to brake caliper

*BA42.10-P-1002-10F
133

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap42.00-p-4280ba, Replace brake fluid


Page 1 of 6
MODEL 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94, 210, 170, 208 (except , 208.474) except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 202, 210, 215 (except , 210.072 /272) with CODE (472) ...

Front axle, model 215, 220:

7
8

Lower vehicle
Disconnect brake fluid changing equipment

Correct the fluid level in the brake fluid


reservoir (10)
Close cap (11)
Replacing brake fluid without the brake
fluid changing equipment
Pump out brake fluid

10

11

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 140:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10G

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 170:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12I

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 202:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12P

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 208:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12K

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 210:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12D

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle, model 215, 220:

*BA42.10-P-1001-12F

n Bleed screw to brake caliper

*BA42.10-P-1002-12G

l Socket wrench

*140589030900

Brake fluid change unit


gotis://B_42/43.2_01
j Brake fluid

*BF42.10-P-1001-01A

i Depress the brake pedal fully about 10


times.
i The brake fluid reservoir (10) must not
be emptied completely; if necessary top up
with new brake fluid up to the"MAX" mark
on the brake fluid reservoir (10). The new
brake fluid must escape without any bubbles
through the bleed hose.
i If the reservoir for brake fluid (10) has
been emptied completely, see:

f
f

Bleed brake system

Model 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

AR42.10-P-0010A

Bleed brake system

Model 215, 220

AR42.10-P-0010I

Front axle model 140:

12
13

Correct the fluid level in the brake fluid


reservoir (10)
Close cap (11)

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 170:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10I

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 202:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10P

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 208:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10K

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle model 210:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10D

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Front axle, model 215, 220:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10F

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 140:

*BA42.10-P-1002-10G

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 170:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12I

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 202:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12P

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 208:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12K

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle model 210:

*BA42.10-P-1002-12D

n Bleed screw to brake caliper


Rear axle, model 215, 220:

*BA42.10-P-1001-12F

n Bleed screw to brake caliper

*BA42.10-P-1002-12G

l Socket wrench

*140589030900

j Brake fluid

*BF42.10-P-1001-01A

n Front axle brake caliper


134

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap42.00-p-4280ba, Replace brake fluid


Page 2 of 6
MODEL 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94, 210, 170, 208 (except , 208.474) except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 202, 210, 215 (except , 210.072 /272) with CODE (472) ...

Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10I

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
140
without
special
protection

Model
140 with
special
protectio
n

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10P

Bleed screw to brake caliper

MODEL
170

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10K

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
202.018/020/
022/023/033/
078/080/081/
083/087/093/
120/121/122/
125/133/134/
180/182/193/
194,
Model
202.028
up to 08/95

Model
202.024/025/
026/029/082/
085/086/088/
089/128/188,
Model
202.028
as of 09/95

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10D

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
208

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10F

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
210

M8

Nm

135

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap42.00-p-4280ba, Replace brake fluid


Page 3 of 6
MODEL 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94, 210, 170, 208 (except , 208.474) except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 202, 210, 215 (except , 210.072 /272) with CODE (472) ...

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10G

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
215

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10G

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model 220
except
model
08/18/074/174/
179,
model 220
without special
protection

Model 220
with special
protection,
Model
220.08/18/074/
174/179

14

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12I

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
140

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12P

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
170.435/
444/445/
447/449/
465

Model
170.466

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12K

Bleed screw to brake caliper

n Rear axle brake caliper

Model
202

Nm

136

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap42.00-p-4280ba, Replace brake fluid


Page 4 of 6
MODEL 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94, 210, 170, 208 (except , 208.474) except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 202, 210, 215 (except , 210.072 /272) with CODE (472) ...

Number

Designation

Model
208

BA42.10-P-1002-12D

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Model
210

BA42.10-P-1001-12F

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12G

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
215
except
215.374

Model
215.374

14

Model
220
without
special
protection,
except
model
074/174

Model
220 with
special
protection,
Model
220.074/174

14

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12G

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

j Brake fluid
Number

Designation

BF42.10-P-1001-01A

Brake fluid

Model
140

Model
170

Filling capacity

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

0.7...0.9

0.45 to 0.6

j Brake fluid
137

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap42.00-p-4280ba, Replace brake fluid


Page 5 of 6
MODEL 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94, 210, 170, 208 (except , 208.474) except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 202, 210, 215 (except , 210.072 /272) with CODE (472) ...

Number

Designation

BF42.10-P-1001-01A

Brake fluid

Model
202

Model
208

Filling capacity

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

Model
210

Model
215

0.45 to 0.6

0.45 to 0.6

j Brake fluid
Number

Designation

BF42.10-P-1001-01A

Brake fluid

Filling capacity

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

0.45 to 0.6

0.7...0.9

j Brake fluid
Number

Designation

BF42.10-P-1001-01A

Brake fluid

Model
220

Filling capacity

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0330-01A

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0331-00A

0.7...0.9

140 589 03 09 00
Socket wrench

138

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap42.00-p-4280ba, Replace brake fluid


Page 6 of 6
MODEL 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94, 210, 170, 208 (except , 208.474) except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 202, 210, 215 (except , 210.072 /272) with CODE (472) ...

AR42.10-P-0010-02A

Carrying out bleeding operation


Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake appropriately marked containers. Wear
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes. protective clothing and eye protection
when handling brake fluid.

aDanger!

AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10I

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
129

Model
140
without
special
protection

Model
140 with
special
protectio
n

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10P

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
170

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10K

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
202.018/020/
022/023/033/
078/080/081/
083/087/093/
120/121/122/
125/133/134/
180/182/193/
194,
Model
202.028
up to 08/95

Model
202.024/025/
026/029/082/
085/086/088/
089/128/188,
Model
202.028
as of 09/95

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-10D

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
208

Nm

n Front axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

Model
210
139

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010-02a, Carrying out bleeding operation


Page 1 of 3
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94 except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 except CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP) ...

BA42.10-P-1002-10F

Bleed screw to brake caliper

M8

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12I

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

Model
129

Model
140

Model
170.435/
444/445/
447/449/
465

Model
170.466

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12P

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12K

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
202

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1002-12D

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
208

Nm

n Rear axle brake caliper


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1001-12F

Bleed screw to brake caliper

Model
210

Nm

140

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010-02a, Carrying out bleeding operation


Page 2 of 3
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94 except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 except CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP) ...

140 589 03 09 00
Socket wrench

Open bleed screw on brake caliper (1)


and at an bleeding pressure of 2 bar
allow approx. 80 cm 3 of brake fluid to
flow out free of bubbles.

Close bleed screw on brake caliper (1).

3.1

Model 140 only: Open bleed screw (b)


on master brake cylinder, allow bubblefree brake fluid to emerge, then
reclose.

Repeat bleeding operation at brake


calipers (2, 3, 4).
i Allow fluid to flow at each brake
caliper (2, 3, 4)
until roughly 80 cm 3 emerges free of
bubbles.

P42.10-0261-06

141

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0010-02a, Carrying out bleeding operation


Page 3 of 3
MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.7.93, 202 up to 31.5.94 except CODE (471) Acceleration slip regulation (ASR) MODEL 129, 140 as of 1.6.94, 210 except CODE (472) Electronic Stability Program (ESP) ...

AR43.10-P-0350B
MODEL
208

Removing and installing brake booster

14.1.97

P43.10-2004-09

ed
1
2

Removal, installation

a Danger!

Risk of poisoning due to consuming brake


fluid. Risk of injury due to brake fluid
coming into contact with the skin and eyes.

Remove brake booster (16)

Notes on brake fluid

n
All models

AH42.50-P-0001-01A

p
4

Notes on repairs to brake system

All models

AH42.00-P-0003-01A

Unscrew brake master cylinder (17) on


brake booster

n
On BAS: Observe control module retaining
plate
i Installation: Replace sealing ring (18)

*BA42.10-P-1001-05A

g
5

Checking

p
6

Remove cover under instrument panel


Remove stop lamp switch

Check brake master cylinder (17) for leaks


at rear of piston
Notes on loss of brake fluid which is not
visible externally
Install in reverse order

i Installation: Adjust stop lamp switch


Only pour brake fluid into suitable,
appropriately marked containers. Wear
protective clothing and safety glasses when
handling brake fluid.
i Operate the brake pedal several times
until the vacuum in the brake booster is
reduced (only with vacuum line connected).
i If the brake booster is replaced in
vehicles with Brake Assist (BAS), the brake
booster must be calibrated to the control
module (BAS) using the hand-held tester
(HHT).

AR68.10-P-1500K
AR42.10-P-0040A
AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

AR43.10-P-0350-01A

*BA43.10-P-1002-01A

Visual inspection
Models 129, 140, 163, 168, 170, 202, 208,
210, 215, 220, 460, 461, 463

AH42.10-P-9406-02A

n Brake booster - pneumatic


Number

Designation

BA43.10-P-1002-01A

Nut of brake booster carrier on front end

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar43.10-p-0350b, Removing and installing brake booster
MODEL 208

Model 208

Nm

20

142

Page 1 of 2

n Brake master cylinder


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1001-05A

Nut of brake master cylinder on brake booster

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar43.10-p-0350b, Removing and installing brake booster
MODEL 208

Model 208

Nm

20

143

Page 2 of 2

AR42.10-P-0040A
Removing and installing mechanical stop lamp switch
MODELS 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

21.6.94

P42.10-0217-01

ed
1

Removing, installing

Unplug electrical connector from stop lamp


switch (S9)
Press catch (S9b)
Turn and pull out stop lamp switch (S9), and
adjust

3
4

Remove cover below instrument panel

Model 129
Model 140
Model 170
Model 202
Model 208
Model 210

ra68001290150x
ra68001400150x
AR68.10-P-1500G
AR68.10-P-1500E
AR68.10-P-1500K
AR68.10-P-1500F

i Installation: Pull actuating pin (S9a) all


the way out.
Fully depress brake pedal (24), insert stop
lamp switch (S9) and turn until catch (S9b)
engages.
The actuating travel distance is set
automatically.

Install in the reverse order

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar42.10-p-0040a, Removing and installing mechanical stop lamp switch
MODELS 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210

144

Page 1 of 1

BB00.40-P-0231-01A

MODEL

Specified gear oils (cars, cross-country


vehicles) - survey

Should be used
Can be used
As at 146518

ALL

smart, Sheets 235.71 up to 235.72


Major assembly

SAE grade

Sheet no. 235


.71
.72

Automated manual transmission model 450, 452 with transmission


717.4
Automated manual transmission model 451, 454 with transmission
717.4

Passenger car, sheets 235.0 to 235.74


Major assembly

SAE grade

Front axle (4MATIC)


Rear axle model 163
Rear axle model 164 with rear wheel drive (4 2)
Rear axle model 251 with rear wheel drive (4 2)
Rear axle model 117, 156, 176, 246 4MATIC (4 4)
Rear axle (standard differential)
Rear axle with AMG differential lock
Model 230.479
Model 204.077/277, 211.076/077/276/277, 219.376/377, 230.470/472/474
with code 471/P30
Model 171.473, 203.076/276, 209.377/477
Model 172.475, 231.474/479, 463.270/271/272/273
Rear axle with differential lock model 164, 199
Differential with limited slip
Manual steering
Manual transmission as of transmission sequence number 7 340 241
(717.4 and 716.6)
Manual transmission SG 150/180 (716.5)
Manual transmission NMT 270, 370/400
Manual transmission 700.7 (Citan)

Sheet no. 235


.0
.3
.7

Transfer case VG 150 E


Model 463.270/271

.15

.61

.62

.74

75W-85, 85W-90,
90
75W-140

75W-85
75W-85, 85W-90
85W-90, 90
75W-80W
75W-80W

Cross-country vehicle, Sheets 235.0 to 235.61


Major assembly
SAE grade
Axles
Manual transmission as of transmission
sequence number 7 340 241
Transfer case
Not for transfer case (VG) 150 E

.10

75W-85

Sheet no. 235


.0
.1
.7

.10

.11

.61

85W-90, 90
75W-80W
80, 80W, 80W/85W
(i In hot climate zones SAE 90, 85W-90)
75W-90W
75W-140

Passenger car and cross-country vehicle sheets 236.1 to 236.81 table 1


Major assembly
SAE
Sheet no. 236
grade
.1
.2
.3
Manual steering L 075 Z
ATF
Power steering
ATF
Manual steering (cross-country vehicle)
ATF
Power steering (cross-country vehicle)
ATF
Manual transmission (cross-country vehicle)
ATF
Manual transmission 717.4, sheet 236.6 not for
ATF
GL76/30-5, GL275E up to transmission sequence number
7 340 240
Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, bb00.40-p-0231-01a, Specified gear oils (cars, cross-country vehicles) - survey
MODEL ALL

.6

.7

.8

.9

.10

.12

.14

.15

.16

.81

145

Page 1 of 2

MB 4 and 5-speed automatic transmission without


ATF
regulated torque converter lockup clutch (KB) (722.3/4/5)
sheet 236.8 only for arctic climate
MB 5-speed automatic transmission with regulated torque ATF
converter lockup clutch (KB) for vehicles with rear wheel
drive (722.6)
MB 5-speed automatic transmission with regulated torque ATF
converter lockup clutch (KB) for vehicles with front wheel
drive (722.7)
7-speed automatic transmission 722.9 in combination with ATF
engine 629 irrespective of production period and the oil
pan installed
7-speed automatic transmission 722.9 up to transmission ATF
sequence number 2834526 (except vehicles with engine
629)
7-speed automatic transmission 722.9 as of transmission ATF
sequence number 2834527 (with engine 113, 152, 156, 157,
275, 279)
7-speed automatic transmission 722.9 as of transmission ATF
sequence number 2834527 (except vehicles with engine
113, 152, 156, 157, 275, 279, 629)
Hybrid 7-speed automatic transmission 724.2
ATF
9-speed automatic transmission 725.0
ATF

Passenger car and cross-country vehicle sheets 236.1 to 236.81 table 2


Major assembly

SAE
grade

Sheet no. 236


.06

Transfer case (4MATIC), model 124


Transfer case (4MATIC), model 163, 210
Transfer case (4MATIC), model 164, 166, 251
Transfer case (4MATIC), model 203, 211, 220
Transmission 722.55 in model 164 (hybrid)
MB F-CVT transmission 722.8
Hydraulic circuit transmission 700.4
GL-5 hydraulic circuit (gear set)
7G-DCT transmission 724 in model 117, 156, 176, 242, 246

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, bb00.40-p-0231-01a, Specified gear oils (cars, cross-country vehicles) - survey
MODEL ALL

.10

.12

.13

.20

.21

.25

.26

.41

ATF
ATF
ATF
ATF
ATF
ATF
ATF
ATF
ATF

146

Page 2 of 2

AR46.10-P-0500A
Dismantling and assembling rigid jacket tube
MODEL
129, 170, 202, 208
70
70a
70b
70c
70d
70e
70f
70g
80a
80c

24.10.94

Jacket tube
Ball bearing
Thrust ring
Locking ring
Thrust ring
Disk spring
Retaining ring
Upper steering shaft
Lower steering shaft
Hexagon socket bolt

072 Tube

P46.10-0230-06

c
1
2

Dismantling

Remove retaining ring (70f), disk spring (70e)


and thrust ring (70d)
Push steering shaft (70g) out slightly, remove
locking ring (70c) and thrust ring (70b)
Press ball bearing (70a) out of the jacket
tube using the steering shaft (70g)
Assembling

4
5
b
6

7
8

9
10

11

Remove jacket tube


Detach bolt (80c), remove lower steering
shaft (80a)

Using a suitable tube (072), press the new


ball bearing (70a) in up to the stop in the
jacket tube
Slide steering shaft in (70g) and press
second ball bearing in
Push thrust ring (70b) and locking ring (70c)
together onto the steering shaft

Slide on thrust ring (70d) and disk spring


(70e)
Mount retaining ring (70f) on the steering
shaft (70g) and, using a suitable tube (072),
push on until the disk spring (70e) is fully
preloaded.
Attach lower steering shaft (80a) to upper
steering shaft

AR46.10-P-0400A
g Check lateral runout of lower steering
shaft (80a) (visual inspection).

i Ensure that the locking ring locks in


position correctly in the groove of the upper
steering shaft.
Two locking rings are fitted on vehicles with
contact spirals.

p The disk spring must be preloaded fully;


preload fully using the lower steering shaft, if
necessary.
AR46.10-P-0500-01E

n Steering shaft
Number

Designation

BA46.10-P-1002-01B

Lower clamping screw to upper steering


shaft

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0500a, Dismantling and assembling rigid jacket tube
MODEL 129, 170, 202, 208

Nm

Model 129

Model 170

25

25

147

Page 1 of 2

n Steering shaft
Number

Designation

BA46.10-P-1002-01B

Lower clamping screw to upper steering


shaft

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0500a, Dismantling and assembling rigid jacket tube
MODEL 129, 170, 202, 208

Nm

Model 202

Model 208

25

25

148

Page 2 of 2

AR46.10-P-0910B
MODEL
208

Removing and installing electronic steering lock

8.1.97

91a
Screws
99
Steering column trim
Arrows Nuts

37m
37n
37p
N26/5

P46.10-0403-01

P46.10-0404-01

P46.10-0406-01

P46.10-0405-01

Securing bolts
Nut
Connector
Electronic steering lock

ed

Removing, installing

p Installation
1
2
3
4
5

Replace self-locking nuts and bolts


Remove steering wheel
Remove instrument cluster
Remove cover below instrument panel
Unscrew steering column trim (99)
Detach jacket tube fixing

AR46.10-P-0100C
AR54.30-P-6015EA
AR68.10-P-1500K
i Installation: First of all fit on all nuts and
bolts.
n Tighten the bottom nuts (arrows) first of
all.
n Bolts (91a).

*BA46.10-P-1001-03A

*BA46.10-P-1009-03A

Unscrew nut (37n) of securing bolts (37m)

Turn electronic ignition key into position "1"


and lift securing bolt (37m) up and off

i The securing bolt can only be taken off if


the electronic steering lock is unlocked.

8
9

Separate plug connection (37p)


Take electronic steering lock (N36/5) out of
steering column
Install in the reverse order

10

*BA46.10-P-1002-03A

n Jacket tube
Number

Designation

BA46.10-P-1001-03A

Lower nut, jacket tube to body

Nm

20

BA46.10-P-1002-03A

Upper bolt, jacket tube to body

Nm

20

BA46.10-P-1009-03A

Nut of securing bolt of electronic steering


lock to steering column

Nm

10

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0910b, Removing and installing electronic steering lock
MODEL 208

Model 208

149

Page 1 of 1

AR46.10-P-0810B
MODEL
208

Removal and installation of electronic ignition/starter switch (EZS

P46.10-0400-01

ed
1
2

P46.10-0401-01

8.1.97

P46.10-0402-01

Removal, installation
Remove cover below instrument panel
Unscrew screw from bottom right of
instrument panel
Unscrew escutcheon (36a) from instrument
panel using a claw-type wrench (020)
Remove electronic ignition/starter switch
(N73)

3
4
5

AR68.10-P-1500K

*210589000700

i Installation: Shift lock (36h) points to the


top left

Remove shift lock (36h), by compressing the


retaining clips (arrows) and moving the shift
lock forwards out of the retaining lugs
Disconnect electrical connectors
Install in reverse order

6
7

210 589 00 07 00
Claw-type wrench for escutcheon
on ignition/starter switch

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0810b, Removal and installation of electronic ignition/starter switch (EZS
MODEL 208

150

Page 1 of 1

AR46.10-P-0200B
MODEL
170, 208,
210 as of 1.6.99

Removing and installing contact spiral

P46.10-0397-01

10.1.97

P46.10-0398-01

P46.10-0399-01

Model 208 shown

ed
1

Removal, installation
Remove steering wheel

i Front wheels in straightahead position


Model 170, 208.
Model 210.

Only unscrew fixing bolts (32h) until the


contact spiral (A45) can be removed.

i The fixing bolts are used as an antirotation device or assembly aid at the same
time.

Carefully remove contact spiral (A45) from


jacket tube

i Installation: Push on contact spiral (A45)


up to the stop; the recess must align with
the fixing lug (arrows) and the connector (a,
b).
p If the contact spiral was twisted, e.g.
when the steering coupling was removed
Adjust center position of contact spiral.

g
4

AR46.10-P-0100C
AR46.10-P-0100B

AR46.10-P-0200-01A

Checking
Check contact spiral (A45) for damage

Visual inspection.
i The upper (32f) and lower sections (32g)
of the contact spiral are clipped together and
can only be separated due to the effect of
excess forces or defective assembly. If this
is the case, wind the contact spiral up
carefully and assemble with care, not
pinching or kinking the contact spiral (32e).
p Do not use oil or grease!

Install in reverse order

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0200b, Removing and installing contact spiral
MODEL 170, 208, 210 as of 1.6.99

151

Page 1 of 1

AR46.10-P-0400A
Removing and installing jacket tube
MODEL
129, 140, 170, 202, 208

P46.10-0228-09

P46.10-0229-09

80

Electric steering column adjustment

90

Manual steering column adjustment

Modification notes
23.8.99

Value changed from 8 to 20 Nm

ed
1

Removing, installing

Remove steering wheel

Remove cover below instrument panel

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0400a, Removing and installing jacket tube
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208

Value in BA46.10-P-1001-03A changed

*BA46.10-P-1001-03A

Model 129
Model 140
Model 170
Model 202
Model 208
Model 129 up to veh. ident. end no. 079 794
and 140 up to veh. ident. end no. 123 446

ra68001290150x
ra68001400150x
AR68.10-P-1500G
AR68.10-P-1500E
AR68.10-P-1500K
AR46.10-P-0100A

152

Page 1 of 4

3.1

Model 129 as of veh. ident. end no. 079 795


and 140 as of veh. ident. end no. 123 447
Model 202
Models 170, 208
Model 129 up to veh. ident. end no. 079 794
and 140 up to veh. ident. end no. 123 446
Model 129 as of veh. ident. end no. 079 795
and 140 as of veh. ident. end no.123 447
Model 202
Models 170, 208
Model 129 with ADS, CODE 217a up to veh.
ident. end no. 079 794 and 140 with ADS,
CODE 217a up to veh. ident. end no. 123
446
Model 140
Model 170
Models 129, 202, 208, 210
Models 129, 140
Models 202, 170
Model 208
Model 129
Model 140
Models 170, 202, 208

4.1

Remove carrier plate (32l) with horn and


airbag carbon brushes
Remove contact spiral (A45)

5.1

Remove steering angle sensor (N49)

Remove instrument cluster

7.1

Remove steering lock (37)

8.1
9

Remove electronic steering lock (ESC)


Remove combination switch (S4)

10
11.1

Remove jacket tube trim (99)


Disconnect contact spiral / airbag unit
Models 170, 208
connector
Detach operating switch (93a) and expose, or Vehicles with adjustable steering column
disconnect electrical connector
i Installation: Ensure that control cables
and electrical cables are correctly routed
Detach reinforcement brace (98)
Vehicles with adjustable steering column
Unscrew upper bolt (25a) of steering
p On vehicles with contact spiral, only
coupling
disconnect connector after removing the
contact spiral
n Models 129, 170, 202, 208

12.1

12.2
13

k
k

AR46.10-P-0100B

AR46.10-P-0100C

AR46.10-P-0200A

AR46.10-P-0200B
AR46.10-P-0300A

ra54001406015x
AR54.30-P-6015EC
AR54.30-P-6015EA
AR46.10-P-0900A
AR46.10-P-0900B
AR46.10-P-0910B
AR54.25-P-2800CS
ra54001402800x
AR54.25-P-2800EA

*BA46.10-P-1001-01B

n Model 140 up to veh. ident. end no.


A - 033 950

*BA46.10-P-1001-01A

n Model 140 as of veh. ident. end no.


A- 033 951 to A - 166 259

*BA46.10-P-1002-01A

n Model 140 as of veh. ident. end no.


A - 166 260

*BA46.10-P-1003-01A

i Note technical modifications on model


140:
Bolted connection of steering shaft and
steering coupling
Bolted connection of steering shaft and
steering coupling

BT46.10-P-9110-01A
BT46.10-P-9111-01A

14

Detach lower nuts on jacket tube (71b)

*BA46.10-P-1001-03A

15

Detach upper bolts on jacket tube (71a)

n i Installation:
Do not tighten bolts and nuts (the jacket
tube must remain adjustable). Electric
jacket tube:
Tighten the upper bolts first
Rigid and manually adjustable jacket
tube:
Tighten the bottom nuts first

*BA46.10-P-1002-03A

16

Pull jacket tube with lower steering shaft out


of steering coupling (25) and remove

p Do not use force as the lower steering


shaft (80a) is sensitive to the effects of side
force
i Installation:
Ensure the straight-ahead position of the
jacket tube (triggering lugs must point
towards the combination switch) and
steering gear
Push lower steering shaft as far as
possible into steering coupling

g
17

Inspecting

18

Install in the reverse order

Check lateral runout of lower steering shaft


(80a)

If necessary if tolerance is exceeded:

*BE46.10-P-1001-01A

Replace lower steering shaft (80a).

Test values for steering shaft

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0400a, Removing and installing jacket tube
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208

153

Page 2 of 4

Number

Designation

Model 129

Model 140

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

BE46.10-P-1001-01A

Maximum lateral runout of lower


steering shaft

mm

2.0

2.0

2.0

2.0

2.0

Number

Designation

Model 140 up to veh.


ident. end no. A-033
950

Model 140 as of veh.


ident. end no. A-033
951 to A-166 259

BA46.10-P-1001-01A

Bolt of steering joint

M8

Nm

25

BA46.10-P-1002-01A

Bolt of steering joint

M10

Nm

30

BA46.10-P-1003-01A

Bolt of steering joint

M8

Nm

n Steering shaft

n Steering shaft
Number

Designation

Model 140 as of veh.


ident. end no. A-166
260

BA46.10-P-1001-01A

Bolt of steering joint

M8

Nm

BA46.10-P-1002-01A

Bolt of steering joint

M10

Nm

BA46.10-P-1003-01A

Bolt of steering joint

M8

Nm

20

nSteering shaft
Number

Designation

BA46.10-P-1001-01B

Bolt of steering joint

Nm

Model 129

Model 170

30

30

Model 202

Model 208

30

30

Model 170

Model 202

nSteering shaft
Number

Designation

BA46.10-P-1001-01B

Bolt of steering joint

Nm

n Jacket tube
Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0400a, Removing and installing jacket tube
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208

Model 129

Model 140

154

Page 3 of 4

BA46.10-P-1001-03A

Lower nut, jacket tube to body

Nm

20

20

BA46.10-P-1002-03A

Upper bolt, jacket tube to body

Nm

20

20

20

20

n Jacket tube
Number

Designation

BA46.10-P-1001-03A

Lower nut, jacket tube to body

Nm

20

BA46.10-P-1002-03A

Upper bolt, jacket tube to body

Nm

20

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.10-p-0400a, Removing and installing jacket tube
MODEL 129, 140, 170, 202, 208

Model 208

155

Page 4 of 4

AR46.30-P-0100GH
Checking oil pressure of power steering pump
27.1.09
MODEL
129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465
/470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 /274 /281 /282 /283 /663, 211.061 /065 /070
/076 /080 /082 /083 /261 /265 /270 /276 /280 /282 /283
MODEL
202.133 /134 /193 /194 except CODE (480) Rear axle level control system
MODEL
220.063 /065 /070 /075 /165 /170 /175 except CODE (487) Active Body Control (ABC)

P46.30-0242-01

P46.30-0243-01

P46.30-0244-01

Shown on engine 112 in model 163


30g
30i

Reservoir cap
High pressure expansion hose

038a Connection fitting

038b Connection fitting

Shown on engine 112 in model 163


038a
038b
039
039a
30g
30i

Connection fitting
Connection fitting
Tester
Throttle valve
Reservoir cap
High pressure expansion hose

P46.30-0245-02

Modification notes
18.4.06

e
1.1

Banjo bolt, high pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

Model 211 with engine 112, 113

*BA46.30-P-1002-01M

Removing
Open reservoir cap (30g) and extract oil from Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 211, 220
reservoir of power steering pump.
Model 210 without adaptive damping system
(ADS) with level control, code 216b.
l Hand pump
Model 210 with adaptive damping system
(ADS) with level control, code 216b.

*210589007100

l Clamping device

*000589403700

1.2

Detach feed line from reservoir

Detach high pressure expansion hose (30i)


from power steering pump

i On vehicles with tandem pump the test


equipment must not be connected to the
pressure oil pump for adaptive damping
system (ADS) with level control, code 216b.

Attach connection fitting (038a) to highpressure expansion hose (30i)

i Special tool 210 589 09 63 00 has been


replaced by special tool 215 589 01 63 00.
Both special tools can be used for carrying
out the test.

Attach connection fitting (038b) to power


steering pump

i Special tool 210 589 09 63 00 has been


replaced by special tool 215 589 01 63 00.
Both special tools can be used for carrying
out the test.

l Connection fitting

*215589016300

156

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0100gh, Checking oil pressure of power steering pump
Page 1 of 5
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

6
7

e
a Danger!

8
9
g
10

Connect test equipment (039) between


connection fitting (038a) and connection
fitting (038b)
Remove clamp from feed line from reservoir

l Testing unit

Model 210 with adaptive damping system


(ADS) with level control, code 216b.
AP46.00-P-4611BB

Risk of accident from vehicle starting off by


Secure vehicle to prevent it moving off.
itself when engine running. Risk of injury
Wear closed and close-fitting work clothes.
from bruises and burns if you hold your hand Do not touch hot or rotating parts.
into engine when it is started or when it is
running.
Start engine
Increase engine speed to approx. 1000 rpm
Checking
p Only carry out the test briefly so that the
oil temperature does not rise unacceptably.
Model 129.059 /064 /068, 163, 170.465,
202.026/ 029/ 086/ 089 /033 /093 /133 /134
/193 /194, 208.365 /465 /370 /374 /470,
210.06 /081 /082 /26 /281 /282 /663 /070
/074 /083 /270 /274 /283
Model 211
Model 220.063/065/070/075/165/170/175
without Active Body Control (ABC), code
487a

Close throttle cock (039a) and check


maximum operating pressure.

Turn off engine


Extract fluid out of the power steering
pump's fluid reservoir

12.2

Detach feed line from reservoir

13

Disconnect testing unit (039)


Install

15

*215589016300
*124589062100

Fill supply reservoir


Check and correct power steering fluid level

11
12.1

d
14

l Connection fitting

AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

*BE46.30-P-1001-01A

*BE46.30-P-1001-01C
*BE46.30-P-1001-01B

Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 211, 220


Model 210 without adaptive damping system
(ADS) with level control, code 216b.

Check O-ring on high-pressure expansion


hose (30i) and replace if necessary
Screw high-pressure expansion hose (30i)
onto power steering pump

l Hand pump
Model 210 with adaptive damping system
(ADS) with level control, code 216b.

*210589007100

l Clamping device

*000589403700

i Model 129.059/ 064/ 068, 163./154 /157


/172/174/175, 170, 202.026 /029 /033 /086
/089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470,
210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083
/261 /263 /265 /270 /274 /281 /282 /283
/663, 202.133 /134 /193 /194 without level
control:
n High-pressure expansion hose to power
steering pump

*BA46.30-P-1003-01A

iModel 211 with engines 112, 113:


n Banjo bolt, high pressure expansion hose *BA46.30-P-1002-01M
to power steering pump
i Model 220.063 /065 /070 /073 /075 /165
/170 /173 /175 without Active Body Control
(ABC), code 487a:

16

Remove clamp from feed line from reservoir

17

Fill power steering pump and bleed

n High-pressure expansion hose to power *BA46.30-P-1003-01C


steering pump
Model 210 with adaptive damping system
(ADS) with level control, code 216b.
Model 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 AR46.30-P-0010B
/174 /175, 170.465 /202.026 /029 /033 /086
/089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470,
210, 220.063 /065 /070 /075 /165 /170 /175
Model 211.061/ 065/ 070/ 076/ 261/ 265/
AR46.30-P-0010P
270/ 276/ 080/ 082/ 083/ 280/ 282/ 283

18

Inspect power-steering pump for leaks

g Carry out visual inspection.

Power steering pump test specifications


Number

Designation

Model
129.059/064

Model
129.068

Model
163

Model
170.465

157

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0100gh, Checking oil pressure of power steering pump
Page 2 of 5
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

BE46.30-P-1001-01A

Pressure in power steering


pump

bar

107-115

107-115

92-100

107-115

Model
202.026/
029/086/089

Model
202.033/093

Model
202.133/134/
193/ 194

Model
208.365/465

105-115

105-115

107-115

105-115

Model
208.370/374/470

Model
281/282l
210.06/081/
082/26/282// 663

Model
210.070/074/
083/270/274/283

105-115

107-115

107-115

Power steering pump test specifications


Number

Designation

BE46.30-P-1001-01A

Pressure in power steering


pump

bar

Power steering pump test specifications


Number

Designation

BE46.30-P-1001-01A

Pressure in power steering


pump

bar

Power steering pump test specifications


Number

Designation

BE46.30-P-1001-01C

Pressure in power steering


pump

Model
211

bar

120...128

Power steering pump test specifications


Number

Designation

BE46.30-P-1001-01B

Pressure in power steering


pump

Model
220.063/065/070
/075/165/170/17
5 without code
487a

bar

120...128

n Power steering pump


Number

Designation

Model
129.059/
064/068

Model
Model
163.128/154/157/ 170
172/174/175

158

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0100gh, Checking oil pressure of power steering pump
Page 3 of 5
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

BA46.30-P-1003-01A

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

M14 1.5

Nm

M16 1.5

Nm

45

45

45

n Power steering pump


Number

Designation

BA46.30-P-1003-01A

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

Model
202.026/029/
033/086/088/
089/093

Model
202.133/134/
193/194
without level
control

M14 1.5

Nm

30

M16 1.5

Nm

40

45

n Power steering pump


Number

Designation

BA46.30-P-1003-01A

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

Model
Model
208.365/370
210.061/062/063
374/465/ 470/474 /
065/070/074/
081/082/083/
261/262/263/
265/270/274/
281/282/283/
663

M14 1.5

Nm

M16 1.5

Nm

40

45

n Power steering pump


Number

Designation

Model
211 with
engine
112, 113

BA46.30-P-1002-01M

Banjo bolt, high pressure expansion hose to


power steering pump

Nm

Designation

Model
220.063/065/
067/070/073/
075/163/165/
167/170/173/
175/875
without code
487a

45

n Power steering pump


Number

159

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0100gh, Checking oil pressure of power steering pump
Page 4 of 5
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

BA46.30-P-1003-01C

210 589 00 71 00
Hand pump

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

000 589 40 37 00
Clamping device

M14 1.5

Nm

M16 1.5

Nm

40

215 589 01 63 00
Connection fitting

124 589 06 21 00
Tester

160

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0100gh, Checking oil pressure of power steering pump
Page 5 of 5
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

AR46.30-P-0010B
Fill power steering pump and bleed
27.1.09
MODEL
129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465
/470, 210
MODEL
220 except CODE (487) Active Body Control (ABC)
MODEL
230 except CODE (487) Active Body Control (ABC)
Model 163, 170, 220,
Model 210 with level
Model 129, 202, 208,
control (tandem pump)
Model 210 without level
control
2
Power steering
expansion
reservoir
2
Power steering
2a Dipstick
expansion
reservoir
47 Air-intake hose

P46.30-2188-01

P32.30-2024-01

Modification notes
23.4.06

Document adapted to the revised procedure

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of injury to skin or eyes caused by


hydraulic fluid spraying out under high
pressure. Risk of poisoning caused by
swallowing hydraulic fluid
Risk of injury caused by fingers being
pinched or crushed when removing,
installing or aligning hoods, doors, trunk lids,
liftgates or sliding roof
Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or
toppling off of the lifting platform.

a Danger!

a Danger!

1
2

Hoist vehicle with lifting platform until wheels


are free
Remove cover of charge air manifold
together with cover above power steering
pump
Fill
Fill the expansion reservoir (2) of the power
steering to approx. 10 mm below the upper
wedge of the container with MB steering
gear oil

Depressurize the hydraulic system


completely before starting any work on the
system. Wear protective clothing and safety
glasses.
Keep body parts and limbs well clear of
moving parts.

AS00.00-Z-0013-01A

AS00.00-Z-0011-01A

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift AS00.00-Z-0010-01A


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.

Model 220.025/125/ 026/126

p Do not start the engine!


If the engine is started there is a risk of air
entering the hydraulic steering system, which
is then extremely difficult to remove.
i Fill the expansion reservoir (2) to approx.
10 mm below the upper edge of the
reservoir with MB steering gear oil.
i Refill with MB-steering gear oil
continuously until the oil level remains
constant.
j Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 220, 230, *BF46.20-P-1001-01A
Model 210 without level control
*BF32.30-P-1001-01A
j Model 210 with level control

Bleeding
Turn steering wheel from steering stop to
steering stop

p Do not start the engine!


If the engine is started there is a risk of air
entering the hydraulic steering system, which
is then extremely difficult to remove.
i Turn steering wheel slowly from steering
stop to steering stop until bubbles are no
longer visible in the expansion reservoir (2).
i Repeat turning the steering from stop to
stop several times (up to 30 times). During
this process, MB steering gear oil must be
poured into the expansion reservoir (2) by a
second person.

161

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0010b, Fill power steering pump and bleed
Page 1 of 3
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210 MODEL 220 except CODE (487) Active Body Control (ABC) ...

a Danger!

Risk of accident caused by vehicle starting


off by itself when engine is running. Risk of
injury caused by contusions and burns
during starting procedure or when working
near the engine as it is running
Start engine without moving the steering

Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving by


itself.
Wear closed and snug-fitting work clothes.
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.

AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

i Allow engine to run for approx. 1 min at


idle speed.
i During this process, a second person
must observe the oil level in the expansion
reservoir (2) and add MB steering gear oil if
necessary.

Turn steering wheel from steering stop to


steering stop

i When the engine is running turn the


steering wheel slowly several times from
steering stop to steering stop, meanwhile
adding MB steering gear oil in expansion
reservoir (2).
i Repeat the procedure until the oil level in
the expansion reservoir (2) remains constant
and bubbles are no longer visible.

g
7

e
e
8

Checking
Check oil level in the expansion reservoir (2)
and fill up to the maximum fill level
Power steering - checking and correcting oil Model 202 up to 31.8.95
AP46.00-P-4611BA
level
Model 202 as of 1.9.95, model 129, 163, 170, AP46.00-P-4611BB
208, 210, 220, 230
Test run engine and check that steering
i If leaks are found, determine the cause
system is not leaking and is functioning
and rectify, subject to separate repair order.
correctly
Install in the reverse order

j Steering gear
Number

Designation

BF46.20-P-1001-01A

Power steering

Filling capacity

Liters

MB steering gear oil

Sheet

Model
129

Model
163

Model
170

1.0

1.2

1.0

BB00.40-P-0236-03A

BB00.40-P-0236-03A

BB00.40-P-0236-03A

Model
202

Model
208

Model
210

1.0

1.0

1.0

j Steering gear
Number

Designation

BF46.20-P-1001-01A

Power steering

Filling capacity

Liters

MB steering gear oil

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0236-03A

BB00.40-P-0236-03A

Model
220
without code
487

Model
230
without code
487

BB00.40-P-0236-03A

j Steering gear
Number

Designation

BF46.20-P-1001-01A

Power steering

Filling capacity

Liters

MB steering gear oil

Sheet

1.0
BB00.40-P-0345-00A

1.0
BB00.40-P-0345-00A

j Level control system


162

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0010b, Fill power steering pump and bleed
Page 2 of 3
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210 MODEL 220 except CODE (487) Active Body Control (ABC) ...

Number

Designation

BF32.30-P-1001-01A

Filling
capacity

Model 210 with level


control/ADS

Level control system, filling


system for the first time

Liters

Specifications for Operating


Fluids

Sheet

Sheet

BB00.40-P-0344-00A

163

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0010b, Fill power steering pump and bleed
Page 3 of 3
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210 MODEL 220 except CODE (487) Active Body Control (ABC) ...

AR46.30-P-0500B
Remove/install power steering pump
14.1.10
MODEL
129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465
/470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 /274 /281 /282 /283 /663
MODEL
220.063 /065 /070 /075 /083 /084 /087 /165 /170 /175 /183 /184 /187 except CODE (487) Active Body Control
(ABC)
Shown on engine 112
30
Power steering pump
30a Reservoir
30b Sealing ring
30c Circlip
30f
Return flow pipe
30h O-ring
30i
High pressure expansion hose
130 Poly-V-belt
Tensioner pulley for poly-V belt
Arrow:

P46.30-2136-06

ed
1.1

Remove/install
Loosen poly-V-belt (130)

i Model 163. only

1.2

Remove poly-V belt (130)

i Except model 163.


Engine 112 in model 129
AR13.22-P-1202B
Engine 113 in model 202, 208 except
208.374, 210, 129
Engine 112 in model 202, 208.365 /465, 210, AR13.22-P-1202BA
220.063 /065 /087 /165 /187
Engine 113 in model 220.070 /075 /083 /084
/170 /175 /183 /184
Engine 113.984 in model 208.374
Engine 112.947 in model 170.465
AR13.22-P-1202SV

2.1

Suction off oil from reservoir (30a)

i Except model 210 with level control.

2.2

Clamp off supply line from reservoir (30a)

i Model 210 with level control.

Detach return line (30f)

iSeal off line connection with blind plug.

l Hand pump
l Clamping device

*210589007100
*000589403700

i Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 210:


n Return flow line at power steering pump

*BA46.30-P-1002-01A

i Model 220:
n Return flow line at power steering pump
4.1

Remove reservoir (30a)

*BA46.30-P-1002-01C

i Model 163. only


i Removal: Use a suitable screwdriver to
pry off retaining ring (30c).
i Installation: First mount reservoir on
power steering pump before it is installed.

Unscrew high-pressure expansion hose (30i) iSeal off line connection with blind plug.
i Installation: Check O-ring (30h) or
sealing rings, replace if necessary.
i Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 210:
n High-pressure expansion hose to power
steering pump

*BA46.30-P-1003-01A

i Model 220 version (A):


164

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0500b, Remove/install power steering pump


Page 1 of 4
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

n High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

*BA46.30-P-1003-01C

i Model 220 version (B) with banjo bolt:


n Banjo bolt, high pressure expansion hose *BA46.30-P-1016-01C
to power steering pump
6.1

Detach high-pressure hose and intake line to i Vehicles with level control. Seal off intake
power steering pump
line with clamp, and line connections with
blind plugs.

Detach power steering pump (30)

n High-pressure hose, tandem pump

*BA46.30-P-1004-01A

l Clamping device

*000589403700

i Vehicles without level control: In addition


detach reservoir (30a) and together with the
power steering pump (30) guide forwards out
of the guide rail.
i Installation: If necessary, replace selftapping bolts, observing the following in the
process:
Never recut thread ,
Only use original bolts,
When screwing in do not attach bolts
obliquely and
Do not use an impact wrench.
Bolts, power steering pump to front timing
case:
Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 210:

8.1

Detach reservoir (30a)

n Self-tapping screw for power steering


pump to timing case
Model 220:

*BA46.30-P-1010-01A

n Self-tapping screw for power steering


pump to timing case
Rear bolts:
Model 129, 163, 170, 202, 208, 210:

*BA46.30-P-1010-01C

n Screw, power steering pump to cylinder


liner collar seat or crankcase
Model 220.063 /065 /070 /075 /165 /170
/175 without Active Body Control (ABC)
Code 487a:

*BA46.30-P-1005-01A

n Screw, power steering pump to cylinder


liner collar seat or crankcase

*BA46.30-P-1005-01C

i Except model 163, 210 with level control.


i Removal: Use a suitable screwdriver to
pry off retaining ring (30c).
i Removal: The reservoir (30a) can also
be removed when the power steering pump
(30) is installed.
i Installation: Check sealing ring (30b),
replace if necessary. Ensure retaining ring
(30c) is seated correctly.

9
10

Install in the reverse order


Fill power steering pump and bleed

AR46.30-P-0010B

n Power steering pump


Number

Designation

BA46.30-P-1002-01A

Return line to power steering pump

BA46.30-P-1003-01A

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

Model
129.059/
064/068

Model
Model 170
163.128/154/157/
172/174/175

Nm

M14 1.5

Nm

M16 1.5

Nm

45

45

45

BA46.30-P-1004-01A

High-pressure hose, tandem pump

Nm

25

25

BA46.30-P-1005-01A

Screw, power steering pump to cylinder


liner collar seat or crankcase

Nm

25

25

165

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0500b, Remove/install power steering pump


Page 2 of 4
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

BA46.30-P-1010-01A

Self-tapping bolt, power steering pump to


timing case

Thread not pretapped

Nm

35

35

Thread pre-tapped

Nm

20

20

n Power steering pump


Number

Designation

BA46.30-P-1002-01A

Return line to power steering pump

BA46.30-P-1003-01A

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

BA46.30-P-1004-01A

High-pressure hose, tandem pump

BA46.30-P-1010-01A

Self-tapping bolt, power steering pump to


timing case

Model
202.026/029/
033/086/088/089/
093

Model
208.365/370
374/465/
470/474

Nm

M14 1.5

Nm

30

M16 1.5

Nm

40

40

Nm

25

25

Thread not pretapped

Nm

35

35

Thread pre-tapped

Nm

20

20

n Power steering pump


Number

Designation

BA46.30-P-1002-01A

Return line to power steering pump

BA46.30-P-1003-01A

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

Model
210.061/062/063
/
065/070/074/
081/082/083/
261/262/263/
265/270/274/
281/282/283/
663

Nm

M14 1.5

Nm

M16 1.5

Nm

45

BA46.30-P-1004-01A

High-pressure hose, tandem pump

Nm

25

BA46.30-P-1005-01A

Screw, power steering pump to cylinder


liner collar seat or crankcase

Nm

25

BA46.30-P-1010-01A

Self-tapping bolt, power steering pump to


timing case

Thread not pretapped

Nm

35

Thread pre-tapped

Nm

20

n Power steering pump

166

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0500b, Remove/install power steering pump


Page 3 of 4
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

Number

Designation

BA46.30-P-1002-01C

Return line to power steering pump

BA46.30-P-1003-01C

High-pressure expansion hose to power


steering pump

BA46.30-P-1005-01C

Screw, power steering pump to cylinder


liner collar seat or crankcase

BA46.30-P-1010-01C

Self-tapping bolt, power steering pump to


timing case

BA46.30-P-1016-01C

210 589 00 71 00
Hand pump

Banjo bolt, high pressure expansion hose to


power steering pump

Model
220.063/065/
067/070/073/
075/163/165/
167/170/173/
175/875
without code
487a

Model
220.083/084/087
/183/184/187

Nm

M14 1.5

Nm

M16 1.5

Nm

40

Nm

25

Thread not pretapped

Nm

35

35

Thread pre-tapped

Nm

20

20

Nm

45

000 589 40 37 00
Clamping device

167

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.30-p-0500b, Remove/install power steering pump


Page 4 of 4
MODEL 129.059 /064 /068, 163.154 /157 /172 /174 /175, 170.465, 202.026 /029 /033 /086 /089 /093, 208.365 /370 /374 /465 /470, 210.061 /063 /065 /070 /074 /081 /082 /083 /261 /263 /265 /270 ...

AR46.40-P-0310A
MODEL
170, 202, 208

Remove/install steering idler arm, replacing bearing bush

11
11e
26
26a
26b
26e
26g
26k

Combined track rod and drag link


Self-locking nut
Steering idler arm
Screw
Self-locking nut
Clamping screw
Heat shield
Bearing bush

"a"

adjustment dimension for ball point


position

P46.40-0210-06

ed

Remove, Install

p Installation
1

Replace self-locking nuts

2
3

4
5

Remove drag link (11) on steering idler arm


(26)
Remove heat shield (26g)
Unscrew nut (26b). Pull out bolt (26a) and
remove steering idler arm (26) with bearing
bush(26k)
Loosen clamping screw (26e)
Remove bearing bush (26k)

The steering idler arm is adjusted in a


defined position "a" = 19.1 mm on the
bearing bush (26k)
"a" = 19,1 mm
6

AR46.40-P-0100C

*BA46.40-P-1001-05A

*BA46.40-P-1003-05A
i Installation: The slight offset of the
steering idler arm must point towards the
collar of the bearing bush/bearing bush
i The adjusted position may be changed
by a maximum of 5 mm by correcting the ball
point position. If the specified ball point
position is not reached within this adjustment
range the bearing tube/body is deformed

Install in the reverse order

n Steering idler arm


Number

Designation

BA46.40-P-1001-05A

Self-locking nut, steering idler arm to


longitudinal frame member bearing bracket

BA46.40-P-1003-05A

Clamp screw, steering idler arm to bearing


bush

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.40-p-0310a, Remove/install steering idler arm, replacing bearing bush
MODEL 170, 202, 208

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

NM

50

50

50

NM

30

30

30

168

Page 1 of 1

AR46.40-P-0210A
MODEL
170, 202, 208

Remove/install tie rod ball joint

14.12.09

P40.30-0288-01

Modification notes
10.9.03

Reference to adjusting toe on front axle replaced by


reference to wheel alignment

Operation step 7

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off of the lifting platform.

p
1

Notes on self-locking nuts and bolts

e
2

3
4
g
5

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift AS00.00-Z-0010-01A


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
AH00.00-N-0001-01A

Remove front wheel


Remove/install wheels

AP40.10-P-4050Z
i Installation: Clean grease off cone and AR46.40-P-0200-02CC
press tie rod joint firmly into steering knuckle.
*BA46.40-P-1002-01A
n

Pry tie rod joint off steering knuckle

l Thrust piece

*129589106300

l Puller

*202589023300

Loosen clamping cone ring (10f), in the


process counterhold at hexagon (10e)
Unscrew tie rod end
Checking
Check tie rod joint for play and damaged
rubber boot

i Replace tie rod joint if necessary.


i The inner ball joint of the tie rod is
permanently connected to the drag link and
can therefore only be replaced with the drag
link.

6
7

Install in the reverse order


Check front wheel toe and adjust if
necessary

See:
Perform a wheel alignment check

AR40.20-P-0200A

n Tie rod
Number

Designation

BA46.40-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut, tie rod to steering


knuckle

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.40-p-0210a, Remove/install tie rod ball joint
MODEL 170, 202, 208

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

Yellow

Nm

50

50

50

silver or blue

Nm

169

Page 1 of 2

129 589 10 63 00
Thrust piece

202 589 02 33 00
Puller

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar46.40-p-0210a, Remove/install tie rod ball joint
MODEL 170, 202, 208

170

Page 2 of 2

AP47.20-P-0780DC
Replace fuel filter
ENGINES
112 in MODEL 170
ENGINES
112, 113 in MODEL 129, 202, 208, 210
ENGINES
113 in MODEL 215, 220
ENGINES
112, 113 in MODEL 230
ENGINES
275 in MODEL 230 except CODE (P99) Special model "AMG Black Series"

23.9.08

Shown on model 210 with engine 112


52
53
55
55/1
56a
59
62
64
74

Fuel pressure hose to engine


Fuel suction hose
Fuel filter
Degassing line
Plastic sleeve
Banjo bolt
Copper sealing ring
Fuel pressure hose
Fuel return line

P47.20-0253-05

Modification notes
9.10.02

Safety information added

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off of the lifting platform.

a Danger!

Risk of explosion caused by fuel igniting,


risk of poisoning caused by inhaling and
swallowing fuel and risk of injury to eyes
and skin caused by contact with fuel
Release pressure relief in fuel tank

1
2
3

f
4

Raise vehicle using a lifting platform


Remove underbody plate
Remove/install underbody protection
Pinch off fuel suction hose (53) and fuel
pressure hose to engine (52)

AS00.00-Z-0010-01A
Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift AS00.00-Z-0010-01A
and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
No fire, sparks, open flames or smoking.
AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
i For this step open fuel filler flap and filler
cap and reseal.
Model 220 with code (Z07) Top protection
AR61.40-P-1000MB
g Installation: Check fuel suction hose
(53) and fuel pressure hose to engine (52)
for damage, replace if necessary.
l Clamping device

Detach hoses lines from fuel filter (55)

i Detach the fuel pressure hose to the


engine (52), fuel pressure hose (64), fuel
return line (74), fuel suction hose (53) and
degassing line (55/1) from the fuel filter (55).
i Installation: Check the hose clamps for
damage and replace if necessary. Only use
the hose clamps listed in the parts catalog.
n Banjo bolt, fuel line to fuel pump or fuel
filter

Remove fuel filter (55)

Install in the reverse order


Checking

g
a Danger!

Risk of accident caused by vehicle starting


off by itself when engine is running. Risk of
injury caused by contusions and burns
during starting procedure or when working
near the engine as it is running
Start engine and check fuel system for leaks

*000589403700

*BA47.20-P-1001-01B

p Installation: Insert the new fuel filter


(55) with plastic film. Do not damage the
plastic film when sliding the fuel filter (55)
into the retaining clamp, otherwise contact
corrosion can occur. Center the plastic film
on the fuel filter (55) in the retaining clamp if
possible.

Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving by


itself.
Wear closed and snug-fitting work clothes.
Do not touch hot or rotating parts.

AS00.00-Z-0005-01A

i Carry out visual inspection.


171

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap47.20-p-0780dc, Replace fuel filter


Page 1 of 2
ENGINES 112 in MODEL 170 ENGINES 112, 113 in MODEL 129, 202, 208, 210 ENGINES 113 in MODEL 215, 220 ENGINES 112, 113 in MODEL 230 ENGINES 275 in MODEL 230 except ...

n Fuel pump
Number

Designation

BA47.20-P-1001-01B

Banjo bolt of fuel line to fuel pump


or fuel filter

Nm

Engine
112

Engines
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
948/960/961/
963/965/966/
967/968/980/
981/984/986/
992/995

Engine
113.991

Engine
275

25

25

25

25

000 589 40 37 00
Clamping device

172

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ap47.20-p-0780dc, Replace fuel filter


Page 2 of 2
ENGINES 112 in MODEL 170 ENGINES 112, 113 in MODEL 129, 202, 208, 210 ENGINES 113 in MODEL 215, 220 ENGINES 112, 113 in MODEL 230 ENGINES 275 in MODEL 230 except ...

AR47.10-P-8021F
Removing and installing expansion reservoir
MODEL
202 as of 1.3.96,
208

7.1.97

Illustrated on models 202, 208.3


93

Expansion reservoir

P47.10-0367-06

ed

Removing, installing

a Danger!

Risk of explosion from ignition. Risk of


poisoning from inhaling and swallowing fuel.
Risk of injury as a result of fuel coming into
contact with skin and eyes.
Hose clip

1
2

Disconnect vent hoses and connection hose


Take expansion reservoir together with filler
neck (93) and cup seal down and out

3
4

Remove guide funnel


Install in the opposite order

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-8021f, Removing and installing expansion reservoir
MODEL 202 as of 1.3.96, 208

No fire, naked flame or smoking.


AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
If fuel tank is full, pump out about 8 liters of
fuel
Emptying fuel tank, filling
AR47.10-P-4001E
i Inspect connection, vent hoses and cup
seal for reuse, replace if necessary
Models 202.0, 208

AR47.10-P-7571D

173

Page 1 of 1

AR47.10-P-4001E
MODEL
202, 208

Draining and filling fuel tank

3.8.94

Draining fuel
012 Drain hose
013 Cap

P47.10-0218-01

P47.10-0219-01

P47.10-0217-01

P47.10-0216-01

Pumping out fuel


012 Drain hose

a Danger!

1.1

Draining or pumping out fuel


Risk of explosion from ignition. Risk of
poisoning from inhaling and swallowing fuel.
Risk of injury as a result of fuel coming into
contact with skin and eyes
Draining fuel
Fit cap (013) together with pressure hose,
take off
Unscrew drain valve screw plug, screw in

No fire, naked flame or smoking


Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel

AS47.00-Z-0001-01A

*202589019000

Check O-ring, replace if necessary.


When installing, ensure it is correctly seated.
p When working on the fuel gauge sender,
only drain the chamber on which work is
being performed. When removing and
installing fuel tank, drain both chambers.
n

Screw drain hose (012) with shut-off cock


into drain valve, unscrew

If no fuel runs out, fuel tank must be


pressurized to approx. 0.15 bar by a brief
pressure surge

1.2

Pumping out fuel


Unscrew drain valve screw plug, screw in

p The drain hose must be touching the


bottom of the safety tank to avoid static
charging.
l
a) Briefly blow into the pressure hose of the
cap (013) with compressed air
b) Insert an air pump (e.g. ball pump) into
the cap (013) of the pressure hose, pump
two or three times and disconnect again
immediately.

*BA47.10-P-1001-01A

i When working on the fuel gauge sender,


only drain the chamber on which work is
being performed. When removing and
installing fuel tank, drain both chambers.
l

Connect suction pump to ground

*202589009000

p Check O-ring, replace if necessary.


When installing, ensure it is correctly seated.
n

Screw drain hose (012) with shut-off cock


into drain valve, unscrew

*BA47.10-P-1001-01A

*202589009000

p Connect suction pump to ground in order


to avoid electrostatic discharge

Connect drain hose (012) with shut-off cock


to suction end of scavenger pump, lock
k

*WE58.40-Z-1001-22A

Pump out fuel through drain valve into safety


tank
Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-4001e, Draining and filling fuel tank
MODEL 202, 208

174

Page 1 of 2

n Fuel tank
Number

Designation

BA47.10-P-1001-01A

Drain valve screw plug

202 589 00 90 00

Nm

Model 202

Model 208

15

15

202 589 01 90 00

Drain hose

Cap

Workshop equipment
WE58.40-Z-1001-22A

Tank emptying device

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-4001e, Draining and filling fuel tank
MODEL 202, 208

175

Page 2 of 2

AR47.10-P-7000E
MODEL
202, 208

Remove, install fuel gage sensor

3.8.94

Fuel tank system of gasoline engines


84/4
89/2
B4/1
B4/2
Y23

Lines from suction spray pump


Shaped seal
Fuel gage sensor in left half of tank
Fuel gage sensor in right half of
tank
Fuel metering pump (only on models
with heater booster or stationary
heater)

P47.10-2028-05

Fuel tank system of diesel engines


84/4
89/2
B4/1
B4/2
Y23

Lines from suction spray pump


Shaped seal
Fuel gage sensor in left half of tank
Fuel gage sensor in right half of
tank
Fuel metering pump (only on models
with heater booster or stationary
heater)

P47.10-0400-05

Fig. item, etc.

Work instructions
Risk of explosion if ignition takes place,
risk of poisoning caused by inhaling fuel
vapors or swallowing fuel as well as risk of
injury to skin and eyes exposed to fuel.
Drain fuel tank, fill

Ring nut

Use pronged wrench for unscrewing,


screwing on.

l
Y23

Fuel metering pump

Unbolt.
i Only fitted to models with heater booster
or stationary heater.

B4/1

Fuel gage sensor

Installation note
Fit on lines (84/4) of suction spray pump at
fuel gage sensor (B4/1).
Insert fuel gage sensor with studs into slots
of fuel tank. Replace shaped seal (89/2).

a Danger!

No fire, sparks, naked flames or smoking.


AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
AR47.10-P-4001E
*BA47.10-P-1004-01A
*202589000700

n Fuel tank
Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-7000e, Remove, install fuel gage sensor
MODEL 202, 208

Model 202

Model 208

176

Page 1 of 2

BA47.10-P-1004-01A

Ring nut for fuel gauge sensor

Nm

55

55

202 589 00 07 00
Puller

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-7000e, Remove, install fuel gage sensor
MODEL 202, 208

177

Page 2 of 2

AR47.10-P-4100E
MODEL
202, 208

Remove/install fuel tank

18.1.10

Tank system for diesel engine


80
80/1
80/2
80/3
80/7
80/8
83/1
90/11
90/12
91
91/1
92
Y23

Fuel tank
Nut
Tensioning straps
Shield
Nuts
Sound deadener
Hose clamp
Fuel return hose
Fuel suction hose
Air admission line
Clip
Vent line
Fuel metering pump (only for model
202.133/193)

P47.10-0399-06

Tank system for gasoline engine


80
80/1
80/2
80/3
80/7
80/8
83/1
84/6
90/11
90/12
91
91/1
92
M3m1
Y23

Fuel tank
Nut
Tensioning straps
Shield
Nuts
Sound deadener
Hose clamp
Degassing hose
Fuel return hose
Fuel suction hose
Air admission line
Clip
Vent line
Fuel pump
Fuel metering pump (only for model
208.374 with Engine 113.984)

P47.10-2026-06

Modification notes
12.8.97
9.4.99

Unscrew fuel metering pump (Y23) only for model


202.133/193
Unscrew fuel metering pump (Y23) only for model
208.374 with Engine 113.984

ed

Remove, Install

a Danger!

Risk of explosion caused by ignition of


flammable products, risk of poisoning
caused by inhaling fuel vapors or swallowing
fuel as well as risk of injury to skin and
eyes exposed to fuel.
Empty/fill fuel tank

No fire, sparks, open flames or smoking.


AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.

j Pay attention to fuel quantity.


Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-4100e, Remove/install fuel tank
MODEL 202, 208

AR47.10-P-4001E
*BF47.10-P-1001-01A
178

Page 1 of 3

2
3

Remove/install complete rear axle


Remove/install fender liner in rear fender

6
7.1

Slacken hose clamp (83/1) from connector


hose-filler neck at the bottom
Pinch off fuel hose (90/12) on the suction
side and degassing hose (84/6) with
Pierburg fuel pump
Remove nut (80/1) of filler neck at bottom
Unscrew fuel metering pump (Y23)

Detach tensioning straps (80/2)

i For this step, support fuel tank with lift.

Suspension of fuel tank modified

n
Model 202, 208

BT47.10-P-0004-01A

Loosen sound deadening mat (80/8)


Sound deadening mat omitted, fuel tank
modified
Unscrew nuts (80/7) from fuel tank

To do so, lower the lift by approx. 30 cm.


Model 202

BT47.10-P-0002-01A

AR35.10-P-0010D
i At right rear.
Model 202

AR88.10-P-1400E

Model 202.018,208

Model 202.133/193
Model 208.374 (AMG)
i Right in front of the fuel level sensor.

k
10

*BA47.10-P-1003-01A

i Fuel tank without rubber naps


n

*BA47.10-P-1002-01A

i Fuel tank with rubber naps


n
11

Remove fuel strainer

12
13

Install in the reverse order


Dispose of fuel tank
Disposing fuel tanks

*BA47.10-P-1006-01A

i Clean and check for re-usability.


n

*BA47.10-P-1005-01A

OS47.10-P-0001-01A

n Fuel tank
Number

Designation

Model 202

Model 208

BA47.10-P-1002-01A

Nut at fuel tank


(fuel tank without rubber naps)

Nm

20

20

BA47.10-P-1003-01A

Nut for tensioning straps

Nm

40

40

BA47.10-P-1005-01A

Fuel strainer in fuel tank

Nm

40

40

BA47.10-P-1006-01A

Fuel strainer in fuel tank


(fuel tank with rubber naps)

Nm

15

15

j Fuel tank
Number

Designation

BF47.10-P-1001-01A

Fuel tank
capacity

Model
202.018/020/023/
024/025/026/
029/033/078/
080/082/083/
085/086/089/093

Model
202.121/122/128
/133/180/182/
188/193

Total filling
capacity

Liters

62

62

Reserve capacity

Liters

j Fuel tank

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-4100e, Remove/install fuel tank


MODEL 202, 208

179

Page 2 of 3

Number

Designation

BF47.10-P-1001-01A

Fuel tank
capacity

Model
208

Total filling
capacity

Liters

62

Reserve capacity

Liters

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.10-p-4100e, Remove/install fuel tank


MODEL 202, 208

180

Page 3 of 3

AR47.20-P-5710AV
Removing, installing fuel pump
ENGINE 112.910
in MODEL
202.026 #A as of 205024,
202.026 #F as of 175421,
202.086
ENGINE 112.920
in MODEL
202.029 #A as of 205024,
202.029 #F as of 175421,
202.089
ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465
ENGINE 113.944 in MODEL 202.033 /093
ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 /470
ENGINE 113.984 in MODEL 208.374

15.3.99

P47.20-2026-09

Shown on model 202 with engine 112

1
2

Trunk cover
Cover

5
6
7
8

9
10

Fuel line (Fuel pump


Fuel line(Fuel pump

3
4

Connector
Rubber grommet

11
12
13
14

Hose clips
Bolt
Plastic sleeve
Bracket

P47.20-2027-09

Cover (fuel pump)


Cable strap
Clip
Fuel line (Tank
fuel pump)

tank)
fuel filter)

181

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.20-p-5710av, Removing, installing fuel pump


Page 1 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 #A as of 205024, 202.026 #F as of 175421, 202.086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 #A as of 205024, 202.029 #F as of 175421, 202.089 ENGINE ...

ed

Removing, installing

a Danger!

Risk of explosion due to igniting fuel, risk


of poisoning due to inhaling and consuming
fuel and risk of injury due to fuel coming
into contact with the skin and eyes.

Disconnect and connect the ground cable at


the battery

2
3
4
5
6

Remove trunk cover (1)


Remove cover (2)
Ascertain as-build condition
Unplug connector (5)
Press rubber grommet (4) out of floor panel

Remove cover (5) of fuel pump

8
9

Remove cable strap (6) and clip (7)


Unclip fuel lines (8, 9, 10)

Fire, sparks, naked flames and smoking


AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
prohibited.
Only pour fuel into suitable and appropriately
labeled containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
AR54.10-P-0003A
i Installation:
After connecting the ground cable, read out
error memory, encode radio and calibrate
power window
Vehicles with stationary heater: set
stationary heater clock.

Fuel line with banjo bolt at fuel pump.

AR47.20-P-5713AU

i Installation:
Check rubber grommet for damage and
correct installation.
p If damaged: replace rubber grommet.
i Unscrew the three nuts of cover through
holes (arrows).
l

*000589543700

*000589403700

i Installation:
Replace hose clips (11).

10

Pull fuel lines (8, 9, 10) off fuel pump (M3)

11
12

Loosen bolt (12)


Remove fuel pump (M3) in direction of arrow i Removal:
p Do not damage the insulation of the
cable and plug of connector (3) when pulling
through floor panel.
i Installation:
p Check plastic sleeve (13) for damage.
If damaged: replace plastic sleeve (56a).
The plastic sleeve (13) must overlap on both
sides of the bracket (14) since corrosion
may occur if the fuel pump touches the
bracket directly.

13

Install in reverse sequence


Overview of fuel pump

000 589 54 37 00

000 589 40 37 00

Clamp

Clamp

GF47.20-P-0025-02A

182

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.20-p-5710av, Removing, installing fuel pump


Page 2 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODEL 202.026 #A as of 205024, 202.026 #F as of 175421, 202.086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 #A as of 205024, 202.029 #F as of 175421, 202.089 ENGINE ...

AR47.31-P-8023D
Removing, installing shutoff valve
ENGINE 111.975 in MODEL 202.024 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version
ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version
ENGINE 112.940 in MODEL 208.365 /465 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version
ENGINE 113.943 in MODEL 208.370 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version
77

Activated charcoal cansister

Y58/4

Activated charcoal cansister


shutoff valve
Hose clips

82/4
C

12.1.98

Activated charcoal cansister line to


shutoff valve

P47.30-2011-06

e d

Removing, installing

a Danger!

Risk of explosion from ignition. Risk of


poisoning from inhaling and swallowing fuel.
Risk of injury as a result of fuel coming into
contact with skin and eyes.
Remove wheel housing liner
Disconnect line (arrow) at shutoff valve
(Y58/4)
Slacken hose clip (82/4) and disconnect line
(C)
Unclip shutoff valve (Y58/4) at bracket of
activated charcoal canister

1
2
3
4

No fire, naked flame or smoking.


AS47.00-Z-0001-01A
Pour fuels only into suitable and
appropriately marked containers.
Wear protective clothing when handling fuel.
Rear left

i On-board refuelling vapor recovery


ORVR function
5

GF47.10-P-3004A

Install in the reverse order

183

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar47.31-p-8023d, Removing, installing shutoff valve


Page 1 of 1
ENGINE 111.975 in MODEL 202.024 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version ENGINE 112.920 in MODEL 202.029 with CODE (491) as of Model Year 99 USA version ENGINE 112.940 ...

AR49.10-P-7000AU
Removing and installing exhaust system complete
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086
ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089
ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465
ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093
ENGINE 113.943 in MODELS 208.370 /470
ENGINE 113.984 in MODEL 208.374

17.11.05

P49.10-2074-09

Shown on model 208 with engine 112.940


9/1
Rubber bushing
11/1
Bolts
11/2
Nuts

ed

11/3
11/4
11/5
158

Nuts
Bolts
Bolts
Catalytic converter

Left lambda sensor upstream of


TWC
G3/4
Right oxygen sensor, before TWC
G3/3x1 Left sensor connector, before
TWC
G3/4x1 Right oxygen sensor connector,
before TWC

Remove/install

G3/3

On model 202.033/093, 208.374 with


engines 113.944, 113.984, note the greater
shore hardness of the rubber mounts
(9/1)!
Disconnect plug connection of left and right
O2 sensors upstream of TWC (G3/3x1,
G3/4x1)
Unscrew bolts (11/1) at flange connection
between front exhaust system / exhaust
manifold

AR14.00-P-5303A

If bolts are sluggish or thread is damaged:

Replace rivet nuts in exhaust manifold.


3
4

Unscrew nuts (11/2) on bracket


Unscrew bolts (11/5) on the suspension of
the rear exhaust system

Lift out exhaust system complete

Install in the reverse order

n
Replace nuts

AR49.10-P-5531-01DA
*BA14.10-P-1002-01B

g Check the rubber mounts (9/1) for


damage, replace if necessary.
i Installation:
Install the exhaust system free of stress,
loosen bolts (11/4) if necessary.
n

*BA49.10-P-1002-01A

n Exhaust manifold

184

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar49.10-p-7000au, Removing and installing exhaust system complete
Page 1 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093 ENGINE 113.943 in ...

Number

Designation

Engine
112
except
112.951/
976

Engines
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986/992/993/
995

BA14.10-P-1002-01B

Flange connection, exhaust manifold and front


exhaust pipes

Nm

20

20

Number

Designation

Engines
112, 113
in model
202

Engines
112, 113
in model
208

BA49.10-P-1002-01A

Bolt, flange connection on exhaust pipe

20

20

n Exhaust system

Nm

185

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar49.10-p-7000au, Removing and installing exhaust system complete
Page 2 of 2
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093 ENGINE 113.943 in ...

AR14.00-P-5303A
Remove/install the oxygen sensor
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086
ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089
ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465
ENGINE 112.921 in MODELS 210.063 /263 /081 /281
ENGINE 112.941 in MODELS 210.065 /082 /265 /282
ENGINE 113.940 in MODELS 210.070 /270
ENGINE 113.980 in MODELS 210.074 /274
ENGINE 113.944 in MODELS 202.033 /093
ENGINE 113.943 in MODELS 208.370 /470
ENGINE 113.984 in MODEL 208.374

25.1.12

Model 202/ 208


Left picture
G3/3
Left oxygen sensor, upstream of
TWC
Diagram right
G3/4
Right oxygen sensor upstream of
TWC

P14.00-0261-01

P14.00-0262-01

Model 202/ 208


G3/3x1 Left oxygen sensor connector
upstream of TWC
G3/4x1 Right oxygen sensor connector
upstream of TWC
G3/5
Left diagnostic sensor
G3/5x1 Left diagnostic sensor connector
G3/6x1 Right diagnostic sensor connector

P14.00-0263-06

Location of diagnostic sensors, Model 202/ 208


G3/5
G3/6
G3/5x1
G3/6x1

Left diagnostic sensor


Right diagnostic sensor
Left diagnostic sensor connector
Right diagnostic sensor connector

P14.00-0265-01

186

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar14.00-p-5303a, Remove/install the oxygen sensor


Page 1 of 3
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 112.921 in MODELS 210.063 /263 /081 /281 ENGINE ...

Shows model 210.081/082


Diagram left
G3/3 Left oxygen sensor, upstream of
TWC
Diagram right
G3/4 Right oxygen sensor upstream of
TWC

P14.00-0249-01

P14.00-0250-01

Illustration is model
210.063/263/065/265/281/282
G3/3x1 Left oxygen sensor connector
upstream of TWC
G3/4x1 Right oxygen sensor connector
upstream of TWC

P14.00-0248-05

Models 210.070/074/270/274
Fig. A
G3/4x1 Right oxygen sensor connector
upstream of TWC
Fig. B
G3/3x1

Left oxygen sensor connector


upstream of TWC

P14.00-0267-06

Modification notes
10.11.04

Value changed from 55 Nm to 45 Nm

Fig. item etc.


G3/3x1, G3/4x1
G3/3, G3/4

Work instructions
Plug connection
Oxygen sensor

Value in series 1001 for engine 112.910/911/ *BA14.00-P-1001-01A


912/913/914/915/916/920/921/922/923/
940/941/942/943/944/945/946/947/949/
953/955/960/961/970/972/973/975

i Installation: Coat thread on oxygen


sensor with heat-resistant lubricant.

*BR00.45-Z-1005-06A
187

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar14.00-p-5303a, Remove/install the oxygen sensor


Page 2 of 3
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 112.921 in MODELS 210.063 /263 /081 /281 ENGINE ...

*BA14.00-P-1001-01A

*000589710300

n O2 sensor
Number

Designation

BA14.00-P-1001-01A

O2 sensor on exhaust pipe/ exhaust


manifold

Nm

Engines
112.910/911/
912/913/914/
915/916/920/
921/922/923/
940/941/942/
943/944/945/
946/947/949/
953/955/960/
961/970/972/
973/975

Engines
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
948/960/961/
962/963/964/
965/966/967/
968/980/981/
982/984/986/
992/993/995

45

55

000 589 71 03 00
Ring wrench socket

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1005-06A

Designation
Paste, hot lubrication 1 kg, DB supply specification 6879.20

Order number
A 000 989 76 51

188

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar14.00-p-5303a, Remove/install the oxygen sensor


Page 3 of 3
ENGINE 112.910 in MODELS 202.026 /086 ENGINE 112.920 in MODELS 202.029 /089 ENGINE 112.940 in MODELS 208.365 /465 ENGINE 112.921 in MODELS 210.063 /263 /081 /281 ENGINE ...

AR49.10-P-5531AV
Removing and installing catalytic converter or front exhaust system
ENGINES
112.940, 113.943 /984 in MODEL 208
ENGINES
112.910 /920, 113.944 in MODEL 202

17.11.05

Shown on engine 112.940


1

Screws

Nuts

Screws

Three-way catalytic converter

Seal ring

Flange connection

G3/3

Left O2 sensor upstream of TWC

G3/4

Right O2 sensor upstream of


TWC

G3/3x1

Left connector upstream of TWC

G3/4x1

Right connector upstream of TWC

P49.10-2075-06

ed
1

4
5

Remove/install
Disconnect plug connection of left and right
O2 sensors upstream of TWC (G3/3x1,
G3/4x1)
Unscrew bolts (1) at flange connection
between front exhaust system / exhaust
manifold

AR14.00-P-5303A

i Loosen flange connection (6) or


Disconnect if necessary.
i If bolts are stiff, or thread damaged:
Replace the rivet nuts in the exhaust
manifold.

AR49.10-P-5531-01DA

*BA14.10-P-1002-01B

*BA49.10-P-1002-01A
n
Unscrew bolts (3) at flange connection
i Installation:
between front exhaust system / rear exhaust Replace nuts and bolts (3) if necessary.
system
Unscrew nuts (2) on bracket
i Installation: Install new nuts.
Remove front exhaust system with three-way i Removal/installation:
catalytic converter (4)
Push rear exhaust system back slightly, or
disconnect rear exhaust system if necessary.
p Ensure that the heat shields of the
exhaust system are not damaged when
removing and installing the three-way
catalytic converter (4).
g Check seal ring (5) for damage and
replace if necessary.
Use emery cloth to remove combustion and
corrosion residues at connection points.

Notes on disposing of catalytic converters

n
Vehicles with three-way catalytic converter
code 620a

Install in the reverse order

i Install catalytic converter free of stress.

*BA49.10-P-1002-01A
OS49.10-P-1000-01A

n Exhaust manifold

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar49.10-p-5531av, Removing and installing catalytic converter or front exhaust system
ENGINES 112.940, 113.943 /984 in MODEL 208 ENGINES 112.910 /920, 113.944 in MODEL 202

189

Page 1 of 2

Number

Designation

Engine
112
except
112.951/
976

Engines
113.940/941/
942/943/944/
945/946/948/
960/961/962/
963/964/965/
966/967/968/
969/971/980/
981/982/984/
986/992/993/
995

BA14.10-P-1001-01B

Nut on exhaust manifold

Nm

16

16

BA14.10-P-1002-01B

Flange connection, exhaust manifold and front


exhaust pipes

Nm

20

20

Number

Designation

Engines
112, 113
in model
202

Engines
112, 113
in model
208

BA49.10-P-1002-01A

Bolt, flange connection to exhaust pipe

20

20

n Exhaust system

Nm

Daimler AG, 8/5/15, G/04/14, ar49.10-p-5531av, Removing and installing catalytic converter or front exhaust system
ENGINES 112.940, 113.943 /984 in MODEL 208 ENGINES 112.910 /920, 113.944 in MODEL 202

190

Page 2 of 2

AR54.10-P-0005EA
Removing and installing battery
MODEL
170, 202, 208, 210, 129

15.2.12

Battery, model 170


1
2
3
4
6
7
8
G1

Screw
Holder
Ground lead
Positive lead
Positive pole cover
Nut
Strap
Battery

P54.10-0278-06

Battery, models 202, 208


1 Bolts
2 Bracket
3 Ground cable
4 Positive cable
5 Vent pipe
6 Positive terminal cover
G1 Battery

P54.10-0005-06

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar54.10-p-0005ea, Removing and installing battery


MODEL 170, 202, 208, 210, 129

191

Page 1 of 3

Battery, model 210


1
Bolt
2
Bracket
3
Ground cable
4
Positive cable
5
Vent pipe
6
Positive terminal cover
G1 Battery

P54.10-0219-06

Battery, model 129


1
2
3
4
6
G1

Bolt
Holder
Ground cable
Positive cable
Positive terminal cover
Battery

P54.10-2017-06

ed

Removal, installation

a Danger!

Risk of explosion caused by escaping


oxyhydrogen gas. Risk of injury caused by
caustic burns to eyes, skin and mucous
membranes from battery electrolyte (contains
diluted sulfuric acid) or metal spatter due to
short circuit. Risk of burn injuries caused
by short circuit. Risk of poisoning caused
by swallowing battery electrolyte (contains
diluted sulfuric acid) or absorption of lead
over the skin or orifices
Notes on battery

No fire, sparks, open flames or smoking.


Wear acid-resistant gloves and clothing and
safety glasses with side guards.
Do not place any conductive objects on the
battery and avoid any short circuit from
battery positive to ground.
Only fill liquid battery electrolyte (diluted
sulfuric acid) into suitable and appropriately
marked containers.

AS54.10-Z-0001-01A

All models

AH54.10-P-0001-01A

Battery version changed


(battery with felt)

i In models 202.028/121/128 a battery with BT54.10-P-0001-01A


felt has been used as of 01/97 for a limited
time.

1
2.1
2.2

Withdraw ignition/glow start key


Remove rear seat
Fold rear seat cushion forward and remove
battery compartment cover

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar54.10-p-0005ea, Removing and installing battery


MODEL 170, 202, 208, 210, 129

Model 210 sedan


Model 210 T-model

AR91.12-P-1700F
192

Page 2 of 3

2.3
2.4
2.5
3
4

Fold trunk cover up


Remove cargo space cover
Remove battery cover in right side of trunk
Connect quiescent current circuit retention
unit
Unscrew screw (1) and remove holder (2)

5.1
6

Unscrew nut (7) and remove strap (8)


Disconnect ground cable (3) at battery

7
8.1
9

Disconnect positive cable (4)


Detach vent pipe (5) at battery (G1)
Remove battery (G1)

Dispose of battery

10

Reinstall in opposite order

Model 202 sedan, 208


Model 202 T-model
Model 129
k

*WH58.30-Z-1004-09A

i Model 202 with 62 Ah and 74 Ah, two


screws
Model 170
p On model 210 insulate cable terminal on
ground lead for protection against
unintentional contact between disconnected
ground lead and ground connection point
W10

AR54.10-P-0003A

Models 202, 208, 210


i If battery is defective
All models

OS54.10-P-0001-01Z

Commercially available tools


Number
WH58.30-Z-1004-09A

Designation
Demagnetizing coil,
Firma BERNSTEIN-Werkzeugfabrik Steinrcke GmbH D-42897 Remscheid-Lennep

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar54.10-p-0005ea, Removing and installing battery


MODEL 170, 202, 208, 210, 129

193

Page 3 of 3

AR60.00-P-0800E
Stamping in vehicle identification number
MODEL
202.0 /1, 208.3, 210.0 /2 /6

30.9.93

1 Cross member
2 Vehicle identification number

P60.00-0287-06

Figure items, etc.


i

Working instructions
Product liability, trademark and traffic laws

All models

AH60.00-P-0800-01Z

Vehicle identification number

EC vehicles

AH60.00-P-0800-02A

USA vehicles
l Number punch guide

AH60.00-P-0800-02B
AR60.00-P-0800-01E
*202589096300

l Number punches

AR60.00-P-0800-02E
*140589266300

l Number punches

*140589266305

Mounting number punch guide


Stamping in vehicle identification number

l Number punch guide

*202589096300

l Number punches

AR60.00-P-0800-03E
*140589266300

Crossing out vehicle identification number


l Number punches

*140589266305

l Number punch guide

*202589096300

Stamping vehicle identification number


into spare field

AR60.00-P-0800-04E
l Number punches

*140589266300

l Number punches

*140589266305

l Number punch guide

*202589096300

Special tools

140 589 26 63 00
Number punch guide

140 589 26 63 05
Number punches

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar60.00-p-0800e, Stamping in vehicle identification number


MODEL 202.0 /1, 208.3, 210.0 /2 /6

202 589 09 63 00
Number punches

194

Page 1 of 1

AH60.00-P-0800-02A

Vehicle identification number

MODEL ALL
EU vehicles

1
2-4
5-10
11
12
13-18
19

Trademark
World manufacturer code
Model designation
Steering
Manufacturing plant
Production number
Trademark

P60.00-0252-05

The vehicle identification number starts and ends with the


"Mercedes star" (trademark) and has 19 punched numbers with a
total length of 106 +/-4 mm.
If, in case of repair, the area where the vehicle identification number
has been embossed is replaced, it is necessary to stamp it in at the
same point.
This involves a change to the vehicle which is subject to
compulsory notification. In the Federal Republic of Germany
immediately inform the vehicle licensing agency in writing.
The vehicle holder is required to complete a certificate for the
vehicle licensing authority which indicates that the vehicle
identification number has been re-stamped after completing body
repairs.
As prove, the original vehicle identification number cut out of the old
part, may also be enclosed.

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ah60.00-p-0800-02a, Vehicle identification number


MODEL ALL EU vehicles

A vehicle identification number incompletely punched in by the


workshop must be crossed out and pinched in correctly in the spare
field on the right crossmember, the right side of the drive shaft
tunnel, the rear partition wall or the firewall.
This procedure should be noted additionally in the certificate for the
vehicle licensing authority as follows:
"The incorrectly or incompletely stamped-in vehicle identification
number was crossed out and the correct vehicle identification
number stamped into in the spare field.".
Export countries must observe their relevant vehicle licensing
provisions and legal regulations.

195

Page 1 of 1

AR33.10-P-0200B
MODEL
170, 202, 208

Remove/install front axle half

12.11.09

P33.10-0208-09

ed
1
2
3.1

3.2
a Danger!

Remove/install
Remove front wheel
Remove front spring (12)
Disconnect rpm sensor connectors (X62/19)
and brake pad contact sensor (S10/1x1) in
major assembly compartment
Disconnect rpm sensor connectors and brake
pad contact sensor in wheel arch
Risk of poisoning caused by swallowing
brake fluid. Risk of injury caused by brake
fluid coming into contact with skin and eyes.
Unscrew brake hose (39) from brake line
(40)

AP40.10-P-4050Z
AR32.20-P-0200B
i Model 202
Pull cable set of front axle out through the
wheel arch.
i Model 170, 208
Only pour brake fluid into suitable and
appropriately marked containers. Wear
protective clothing and eye protection when
handling brake fluid.
Protect lines against contamination

AS42.50-Z-0001-01A

Notes on installing brake hoses

*BA42.10-P-1001-04A
p Installation: n The brake hose must
not be twisted after tightening.
Open double end box wrench, WAF 8x9 mm
or WAF 10x11 mm
Model 129, 140, 170, 202, 208, 210
AH42.10-P-9406-01A

p
5

Brake fluid notes

All models

AH42.50-P-0001-01A

Detach torsion bar (28) from lower control


arm
Remove track rod (10) at steering knuckle

*BA32.20-P-1001-02C

n Check rubber boot and ball joint for wear


and damage

*BA46.40-P-1002-01A

l Puller (050)

*202589023300

l Thrust piece (051)

*129589106300

*BA32.25-P-1002-01B

7
8

Unscrew damper (47) at upper mounting


Support lower control arm (4) and detach at
frame floor assembly

10

*BA32.25-P-1001-01B

i Model 170
Remove lower engine compartment paneling
first

AR33.10-P-0200-01B

*BA33.20-P-1009-01A

i Observe technical modifications


Bearing bracket of lower control arm

k
9

Detach steering knuckle (5) from upper


wishbone (6)

BT33.20-P-9308-01B

n Check rubber boot and ball joint for wear


and damage

*BA33.20-P-1002-01A

l Puller (043)

*124589033300

l Thrust piece (043a)

*210589046300

Remove front axle half

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar33.10-p-0200b, Remove/install front axle half


MODEL 170, 202, 208

196

Page 1 of 3

11
12
p Installation

Remove upper transverse control arm


Install in the reverse order
Replace self-locking nuts and bolts.

13
14

Bleed front brake system


Perform a wheel alignment check

AR33.20-P-0500B
Tighten securing nuts when vehicle in readyfor-the-road condition
AR42.10-P-0010A
AR40.20-P-0200A

n Front axle stabilizer bar


Number

Designation

BA32.20-P-1001-02C

Self-locking nut for attaching retaining bracket to transverse control arm

Nm

Model 202

Type 208

20

20

n Front axle stabilizer bar


Number

Designation

Model 170

BA32.20-P-1001-02C

Self-locking nut for attaching retaining bracket to transverse control arm

Nm

20

n Front axle shock absorber


Number

Designation

Model
202

Model
208

Model
170

BA32.25-P-1001-01B

Nut for shock absorber on front end

Nm

18

18

18

BA32.25-P-1002-01B

Lock nut for shock absorber on front end

Nm

30

30

30

Number

Designation

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

BA33.20-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut, upper wishbone follower


joint to steering knuckle

n Wheel location, hub

BA33.20-P-1009-01A

Initially

Nm

45

45

45

Inspection

Nm

Nm

120

120

120

Self-locking nut, lower wishbone to frame

n Brake lines, brake hoses


Number

Designation

BA42.10-P-1001-04A

Brake pipe to brake hose

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar33.10-p-0200b, Remove/install front axle half


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Nm

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

14

14

14

197

Page 2 of 3

n Tie rod
Number

Designation

BA46.40-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut, tie rod to steering


knuckle

202 589 02 33 00
Puller

129 589 10 63 00
Thrust piece

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar33.10-p-0200b, Remove/install front axle half


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

Yellow

Nm

50

50

50

silver or blue

Nm

124 589 03 33 00
Puller

210 589 04 63 00
Thrust piece M 10x1.5

198

Page 3 of 3

AR46.40-P-0100C
MODEL
170, 202, 208

Remove/install drag link

14.12.09

P46.10-0203-01

P46.40-0205-01

Engine 111, 601, 604, 605, 611

P46.40-2002-01

Engine 112, 113

Modification notes
10.9.03

Reference to adjusting toe on front axle replaced by


reference to wheel alignment

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by vehicle slipping or


toppling off of the lifting platform.

p
1.1

Notes on self-locking nuts and bolts


Remove engine compartment paneling

1.2

Remove bottom section of soundproofing

Detach steering damper (46) from drag link


(11)
Unscrew nuts from drag link (11)

Step 8

Align vehicle between columns of vehicle lift AS00.00-Z-0010-01A


and position four support plates at vehicle lift
support points specified by vehicle
manufacturer.
AH00.00-N-0001-01A
Vehicles with gasoline engine
Model 170
Model 202, 208
Vehicles with diesel engine
Model 202

AR61.20-P-1105A
AR61.20-P-1105AB
AR94.30-P-5300A
*BA46.40-P-1001-03A

n
i Counterhold ball studs if necessary with
Allen wrench.
n

4
5.1

5.2

*BA46.40-P-1001-04A

l
Press drag link (11) off steering gear pitman Engine 111, 601, 604, 605, 611
arm and steering idler arm using puller (053)
l Puller
Press tie rod joints off steering knuckles

Pry off drag link (11) on pitman arm and


steering idler arm using thrust piece (046)
and puller (044)

Check ball joints on drag link (11) for play


and damaged rubber boots

AR46.40-P-0200-02CC

*202589013300

i Installation: Remove grease from cones


and press ball joints firmly into steering arm.
Engine 112, 113
l Puller

*202589023300

l Thrust piece

*129589106300

i Installation: Remove grease from cones


and press ball joints firmly into steering arm.
If necessary replace drag link (11).
i The right drag link joint is a pivot joint
with a swivel range of max. 2. This prevents
pivot movements of the drag link.

7
8

Install in the reverse order


Check front wheel toe and adjust if
necessary

See:
Perform a wheel alignment check

AR40.20-P-0200A

n Tie rod
Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar46.40-p-0100c, Remove/install drag link


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Model
170

Model
202

Model
208

199

Page 1 of 2

BA46.40-P-1002-01A

Self-locking nut, tie rod to steering


knuckle

Yellow

Nm

50

50

50

silver or blue

Nm

n Steering damper
Number

Designation

BA46.40-P-1001-03A

Steering damper to drag link

Nm

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

40

40

40

n Drag link
Number

Designation

BA46.40-P-1001-04A

Self-locking nuts on drag link

202 589 01 33 00
Puller

129 589 10 63 00
Thrust piece

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar46.40-p-0100c, Remove/install drag link


MODEL 170, 202, 208

Stage 1

Nm

Stage 2

Model 170

Model 202

Model 208

50

50

50

202 589 02 33 00
Puller

200

Page 2 of 2

AR91.10-P-1000K
MODEL
208
1
2
3
4, 5, 6 and 7
8
9

Removing and installing front seats

13.2.97

Front seat
Head restraint
Trim panel
Screws
Arresting bolts
Seat adjustment rails

P91.10-0477-06

ed
1
2
3

Removal, installation
Remove head restraint (2) and move front
seat (1) toward rear
Pull off cover (3) on both front seat rails
Unscrew screws (4 and 5)

*BA91.10-P-1001-01A

i Use E12 external Torx socket wrench


attachment.
4
5

Move front seat toward front and fold front


seat backrest forward
Unscrew screws (6 and 7)

*000589011000

*BA91.10-P-1001-01A

i Use E12 external Torx socket wrench


attachment.
l

*000589011000

Remove front seat (1)

i Passenger seat: Separate connector for


the seat occupied recognition sensor.

Install in opposite order

i Before installing position both seat


adjustment rails (9) uniformly to one another.
A maximum offset of 4 mm is permissible.
Insert arresting bolts (8) into holes in seat
mounting console.

n Front seats
Number

Designation

BA91.10-P-1001-01A

Screw on seat rail

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar91.10-p-1000k, Removing and installing front seats
MODEL 208

Model
208

Nm

50

201

Page 1 of 2

000 589 01 10 00
TORX bit set

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar91.10-p-1000k, Removing and installing front seats
MODEL 208

202

Page 2 of 2

AR72.10-P-0500K
MODEL
208

Remove/install front door

16.3.10

P72.10-0431-09

1
2
3
4
5
6

In-door speaker (mid-range speaker)


In-door speaker separation point
In-door speaker (bass)
In-door speaker separation point
Bellows
Door catch

7
8
9
10
11
12

Door seal
Cable duct
Side airbag separation point
Door control unit separation point
Door control unit separation point
Separation point, pneumatic line

13
14
15
16
17

Rocker panel molding


Bolt
Base cover
Bolt
Door hinge

Seam sealing following repair

i Includes seam sealing on driver's door

AR97.10-P-4000K

Cavity preservation following repair work

i Includes cavity preservation on driver's


door

AR97.20-P-1500K

ed
1
2

Remove/Install

Disconnect in-door speaker separation point


(2) and remove in-door speaker (1)
Pull door foil off of inner door panel

4
5
6
7
8
9

Remove door lining


Disconnect in-door speaker separation point
(4) and remove in-door speaker (3)

Remove rocker panel molding (13) with


mounting wedge
Remove door seal (7) from A-pillar
Remove inner base paneling (15) from Apillar
Open cable duct (8) at front
Disconnect pneumatic line separation point
(12)

AR72.10-P-1000K
i Remove sound deadening mat from indoor speaker (4)
Installation: Replace tie straps
i Installation: Replace tie straps.
i Installation: Replace damaged door foil, *BR00.45-Z-1004-02A
glue door foil onto inner door panel
*110589035900

p Danger of breaking insert profiles


i A 7 mm open-end wrench can be used
to separate the pneumatic line (12)

10
11
12
13

Disconnect side airbag separation points (9)


and door control unit (10, 11)
Pull wiring harness through bellows (5) on Apillar and unclip bellows (5) from front door
Remove door catch (6) from A-pillar.
n
Unscrew bolts (16) from bottom and top
p Hold door with aid of 2nd person to
hinge and slightly pull door away from Aprevent damaging paint.
pillar
i Installation: Position front door to
centering bolts with hinges (17), screw on
with bolts (16) and tighten
n

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar72.10-p-0500k, Remove/install front door


MODEL 208

*BA72.10-P-1003-01A

*BA72.10-P-1001-01A
203

Page 1 of 3

14

Remove front door and lay down on secure


base
Install in the reverse order
Check gap dimensions at door all the way
around

15
16

p Do not damage paintwork


l

*129589032100

*BE60.00-P-1002-01A
i Dimensions
Gaps dimensions at hoods, doors and covers AR60.00-P-0700-01K
AR72.10-P-0550G
i If applicable, adjust front door
Test and adjustment values, gap dimensions at hoods, doors and covers
Number

Designation

Model
208.3

Model
208.4

BE60.00-P-1002-01A

Gap
Front door to A-pillar
dimension

Dimension
"B"

mm

6.5 ( 0.5)

5.0 ( 1.0)

Front door to fender

Dimension
"H"

mm

4.0 ( 0.5)

4.0 ( 0.5)

Front door to rear door

Dimension
"I"

mm

Front door to roof

Dimension
"C"

mm

Rear door to upper side section

Dimension
"D"

mm

Rear door to lower side section

Dimension
"J"

mm

Fender to A-pillar

Dimension
"Q"

mm

Front door to rear fender

Dimension
"P"

mm

4.0 ( 0.5)

4.0 ( 0.5)

Fig., see

AR60.00-P-0700-01K
AR60.00-P-0700-01K
A

n Front door
Number

Designation

BA72.10-P-1001-01A

Bolt to door hinge

Nm

37

BA72.10-P-1003-01A

Bolt to door catch on A-pillar

Nm

25

110 589 03 59 00
Mounting wedge

Model
208.3/4

129 589 03 21 00
Feeler gage

Repair materials
Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar72.10-p-0500k, Remove/install front door
MODEL 208

204

Page 2 of 3

Number
BR00.45-Z-1004-02A

Designation
Adhesive PVC 914

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar72.10-p-0500k, Remove/install front door


MODEL 208

Order number
A 001 989 30 71

205

Page 3 of 3

AR68.10-P-1000K
MODEL
208
1
2
3 and 5
4
12

Removing and installing instrument panel

20.2.97

Instrument panel
Housing
Screws
Covers
Connector

P68.10-0485-06

1
6,7,8 and 9
10
11

Instrument panel
Screws
Gasket
Defroster nozzle

P68.10-0490-06

ed
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10

Removal, installation
Remove steering wheel
Remove instrument cluster
Remove bottom section of instrument panel
on driver's side
Remove bottom section of instrument panel
on passenger side
Remove center console
Remove side air nozzles on left and right
Remove center air nozzle
Remove paneling on A-pillars on left and
right
Unscrew screw (3) and remove housing (2)
Disconnect connector (12) on housing (2)
and lay housing down (2)

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar68.10-p-1000k, Removing and installing instrument panel
MODEL 208

AR46.10-P-0100C
AR54.30-P-6015EA
AR68.10-P-1505K
AR68.10-P-1507K
AR68.20-P-2000K
AR68.10-P-1100K
AR68.10-P-1150K
AR68.30-P-4050K

206

Page 1 of 2

11
12
13
14

15
16

Unclip cover (4) on left and right at top and


remove
Unscrew screws (5) on left and right
Unscrew screws (6, 7, 8 and 9)
Lift instrument panel (1), pull toward rear and iInstallation: Insert sheet metal clip nuts (6
remove
each) for fastening instrument panel.
Check gasket (10) above air outlet on
heater housing and replace, if necessary.
Insert instrument panel (11) with defroster
nozzles (11) on heater housing, expose
electrical wires.
Check for proper function, set clock and
adjust side windows, code radio
Lay instrument panel (1) down on suitable
surface
Reinstall in opposite order

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar68.10-p-1000k, Removing and installing instrument panel
MODEL 208

207

Page 2 of 2

AR88.40-P-3000K
MODEL
208.3 /4

Removing and installing engine hood

10.1.97

P88.40-0314-09

1
2
3

Engine hood
Cover
Connector

4
5

Water hose
Windshield washer nozzle

6
7

Engine hood hinge


Screw

ed

Removal, installation

a Danger!

Risk of injury from fingers being pinched


or jammed when removing and installing
and aligning hoods, doors, trunk lids/tailgates
and sliding roof
Move engine hood (1) to upright position
Attach fender guards
Unclip cover (2) and disconnect connectors
(3)
Pull water hose (4) off of windshield washer
nozzle (5) and pull out of engine hood (1)
Mark installation position of engine hood (1)
on engine hood hinges (6)
Unscrew screws (9) on engine hood (1)

When moving components ensure that no


AS00.00-Z-0011-01A
body parts or limbs are in the area of motion.

Remove engine hood (8) with aid of second


person and set down on suitable surface

p Avoid damaging paint

1
2
3
4
5
6
7

Reinstall in opposite order

AR88.40-P-1000F

i This facilitates installation


p Have second person secure engine hood *BA88.40-P-1001-01A
n Screw on engine hood

i Installation: Insert engine hood (1) into


hinge (6) (see arrow).
When replacing engine hood supplement
standard joint seal and hollow cavity
preservation.
See
Sealing weld after repairs
Model 208.3
Model 208.4
Processing of corrosion protection materials
before painting
Hollow cavity preservation following repair

Adjust engine hood

AR88.40-P-3020K

AR97.10-P-4000K
AR97.10-P-4000KA
AR97.20-P-0500A
AR97.20-P-1500K
AR88.40-P-3020K

n Engine hood
Number

Designation

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar88.40-p-3000k, Removing and installing engine hood
MODEL 208.3 /4

Model
208.3/4

208

Page 1 of 2

BA88.40-P-1001-01A

Screws on engine hood

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar88.40-p-3000k, Removing and installing engine hood
MODEL 208.3 /4

Nm

10

209

Page 2 of 2

AR88.10-P-1000K
MODEL
208.3/ 4
1
2
3
4
5

Remove/install front fenders

10.1.97

Fenders
Cover
Turn signal lamp
Bolt
Bolt

P88.10-0266-06

ed

Remove/Install

When replacing front fender apply MB


permanent underbody protection, preserve
with cavity wax following installation
i Cavity wax
Use approved wax preservative, see service
microfiche, specifications for operating fluids,
sheet no. 385

1
2
3
4
5
6
7

Open engine hood and move to upright


position
Remove fender liner in front fender
Remove front bumper
Unscrew headlamp mounting bolts (4)

AR88.40-P-1000F

AR88.20-P-2000K
i Do not remove headlamp.

Remove cover (2)


Disconnect connector and remove turn signal
lamp (3)
Remove door retaining strap from A-pillar
i Better accessibility to bolts (5) on A-pillar
p Avoid damaging paint on door and front
fender
n Bolt at door catch

Unscrew bolts (5).

p Avoid damaging paint.

Remove fender (1) toward front

10

Install in the reverse order

p Avoid damaging paint.


When replacing fender supply standard
seam sealing, underbody and cavity
preservation
Refer to:
Seam sealing following repair
Model 208.3
Model 208.4
Processing of corrosion protection materials
before painting
Cavity preservation following repair work

11

Check gaps on fender (1), correct

l Feeler gage
i Dimensions
Gap dimensions at hoods, doors and covers
Model 208.3
Gap dimensions at hoods, doors and covers
Model 208.4
Gaps of hood
Gaps of fender

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar88.10-p-1000k, Remove/install front fenders


MODEL 208.3/ 4

*BA72.10-P-1003-01A

AR97.10-P-4000K
AR97.10-P-4000KA
AR97.20-P-0500A
AR97.20-P-1500K
*129589032100
AR60.00-P-0700-01K
AR60.00-P-0700-01KA
*BE60.00-P-1001-01A
*BE60.00-P-1002-01A
210

Page 1 of 2

Test and adjustment values, gap dimensions at hoods, doors and covers
Number

Designation

BE60.00-P-1001-01A

Gap
Engine hood to fender
dimension

Model 208.4

Dimension "A"

mm

4.0 ( 0.5)

4.0 ( 0.5)

Engine hood to headlamp

Dimension "R"

mm

6.0 ( 1.1)

6.0 ( 1.1)

Engine hood to radiator grille

Dimension "O"

mm

Radiator grill to headlamp

Dimension "N"

mm

AR60.00-P-0700-01K

Fig., see

BE60.00-P-1002-01A

Model 208.3

AR60.00-P-0700-01K
A

Gap
Front door to A-pillar
dimension

Dimension "B"

mm

6.5 ( 0.5)

5.0 ( 1,0)

Front door to fender

Dimension "H"

mm

4.0 ( 0.5)

4.0 ( 0.5)

Front door to rear door

Dimension "I"

mm

Front door to roof

Dimension "C"

mm

Rear door to upper side section

Dimension "D"

mm

Rear door to lower side section

Dimension "J"

mm

Fender to A-pillar

Dimension "Q"

mm

Front door to rear fender

Dimension "P"

mm

4.0 ( 0.5)

4.0 ( 0.5)

Fig., see

AR60.00-P-0700-01K
AR60.00-P-0700-01K
A

n Front door
Number

Designation

BA72.10-P-1003-01A

Bolt, door catch on A-pillar

Model
208.3/4

Nm

25

129 589 03 21 00
Feeler gage

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar88.10-p-1000k, Remove/install front fenders


MODEL 208.3/ 4

211

Page 2 of 2

AR67.10-P-1000K
MODEL
208.3/ 4

Remove/install windshield

11.3.10

Illustrated on model 208.3


1

Windshield

P67.10-0279-06

Modification notes
18.7.08

Note on painting in the glazing area added

Step 12

Removing

a Danger!

Risk of injury due to tear or warming up of Wear protective gloves and safety glasses.
AS67.00-Z-0004-01A
cutting wire and through glass splinters
when cutting out glued windows
Risk of injury caused by moving parts
Always remove ignition key when working on AS82.30-Z-0001-01A
that can pinch, crush or, in extreme cases windshield wiper mechanism.
even sever extremities.
Prepare 1-component adhesive cartridge
AR67.10-P-1000-12SX
*000589866300
l Intermediate piece

a Danger!
1

Cartridge preheater, cartridge gun


gotis://K_67.0_02.0
Repair kit
2
3
4
5
6
7
8

Remove both panelings from outside of Apillar


Remove ornamental frame on windshield.
Remove wiper system
Remove rain sensor (B38)
Remove inside rearview mirror
Remove left and right bracket at lower Apillar
Cut out windshield (1) with Roll Out 2004
window removal tool

Remove windshield (1) from body with Cup


suction tools

With code (345) Rain sensor


On model 208.4

Roll out 2004 window removal tool


gotis://K_67.0_01.0
Suction lifting device
gotis://K_67.0_03.0

*BR00.45-Z-1089-02A
AR88.80-P-8500K
AR67.10-P-1200K
AR82.30-P-6400E
AR82.30-P-7700F
AR68.40-P-0001KA

AR67.10-P-1000-11SX

i Aid of helper required.


Suction lifting device
gotis://K_67.0_03.0

d
10

Install

11

Prepare windshield (1) for installation

Replace rubber spacers

i Do not remove protective foil.


Repair kit
Repair kit

12
p

Prepare body flange for installation


General notes about painting the body flange Pay attention to notes concerning the
in the glazing area
preparation of new parts such as the A-pillar,
the roof or the side walls.

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar67.10-p-1000k, Remove/install windshield


MODEL 208.3/ 4

AR67.10-P-1000-02K
AR67.10-P-1000-03P
*BR00.45-Z-1015-02A
*BR00.45-Z-1089-02A
AR67.10-P-1501-01P
AH98.00-P-9408-06A
212

Page 1 of 3

Wet and dry vacuum cleaner


gotis://P_00.12_06.0
Repair kit
Repair kit
Touch-up pencil
Hepox 2K EP primer filler 4017 (Spray Max)
13

Align windshield (1) in the body opening

i Aid of helper required.

*BR00.45-Z-1015-02A
*BR00.45-Z-1089-02A
*BR00.45-Z-1012-07A
*BR00.45-Z-1050-07A
AR67.10-P-1000-04K

i Observe gap

14
15

Remove protective foil from rubber spacers


Apply adhesive material

l Feeler gauge
Suction lifting device
gotis://K_67.0_03.0
Distance between top edge of window and
front edge of roof

*129589032100

pInstall windshield (1) within 10 minutes


before adhesive force of adhesive material
starts to decrease.

AR67.10-P-1000-08P

*BE67.10-P-1001-01A

i Height of glue bead approx. 13 mm.


l Intermediate piece
Cartridge gun
gotis://K_67.0_02.0
Repair kit
Repair kit
16

p Open side window in driver door for the


duration of the curing time to prevent the
windshield (1) from being pressed outwards
by the air pressure when the doors are
closed.

Install windshield (1)

*000589866300

*BR00.45-Z-1015-02A
*BR00.45-Z-1089-02A
AR67.10-P-1503-01K

i Aid of helper required. The waiting time


(drive-away time) is approx. 1 h calculated
from the time the windshield (1) is installed.
Suction lifting device
gotis://K_67.0_03.0
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24

Install ornamental frame on wind deflector


Install both panels on outside of A-pillar
Install wiper system
Install left and right bracket on lower A-pillar
Install inside rearview mirror
Install rain sensor
Clean windshield (1)
Code adaptation of rain sensor and light
sensor amplification factor and select type of
windshield
Connect STAR DIAGNOSIS and read out
fault memory

AR67.10-P-1200K
AR88.80-P-8500K
AR82.30-P-6400E
On model 208.4
With code (345) Rain sensor

AR68.40-P-0001KA
AR82.30-P-7700F

i On vehicles with code (345) Rain sensor.


Engine hood and driver door must be closed.
AD00.00-P-2000-04A

Test and adjustment values for windshield


Number

Designation

Model 208

BE67.10-P-1001-01A

Distance between window upper


edge and front edge of roof

Dimension
"A"
See picture

129 589 03 21 00
Feeler gauge

mm

12

AR67.10-P-1000-04K

000 589 86 63 00
Intermediate piece

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar67.10-p-1000k, Remove/install windshield


MODEL 208.3/ 4

213

Page 2 of 3

Repair materials
Number
BR00.45-Z-1015-02A
BR00.45-Z-1089-02A

BR00.45-Z-1012-07A
BR00.45-Z-1050-07A

Designation
Repair kit, glazing, installing window, 2-component adhesive
Repair kit, installing window, 1-component adhesive, replaced by: A 221
670 81 01
Primer stick
Hepox 2K EP primer filler 4017 (Spray Max)

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar67.10-p-1000k, Remove/install windshield


MODEL 208.3/ 4

Order number
A 220 670 00 93
A 221 670 21 01
A 000 986 27 50
Spies Hecker GmbH
Fritz-Hecker-Str. 47-107
50968 Kln
Germany
Tel. +49 221 370606
Fax. +49 221 3706410
www.spieshecker.com

214

Page 3 of 3

AR88.20-P-2000K
MODEL
208

Removing and installing front bumper

11.2.97

P88.20-0326-09

2
3

Lining
Fog lamp connector

1
8
9

Bumper
Screw
Telescoping nozzle for headlamp
cleaning system
Telescoping nozzle cover
Screw
Nut

10
11
12

4
5

Screw
Outside temperature sensor

6
7

Spreading rivet
Rotary clip

P88.20-0332-06

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar88.20-p-2000k, Removing and installing front bumper
MODEL 208

215

Page 1 of 3

P88.20-0337-09

13
14
15

e
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8

9
10.1

11
d
12

13
14
15

16
17

Guide
Holder
Centering pin

16
17

Holder
Intermediate layer

18

Fender tip
C
Gap dimension from headlamp
lens to bumper cover

Removal
Remove paneling (2)
Disconnect fog lamp connector (3)
Unscrew screw (4)
Disconnect outside temperature sensor (5)
Remove spreading rivet (6) from wheelhouse
panel
Open rotary clip (7) on side of fender flange
Unscrew screws (8)
Remove cover (9) on telescoping nozzle (10) With SAA 500.305/01
Headlamp cleaning system
i Have second mechanic press headlamp
cleaning system switch momentarily until
telescoping nozzle (10) extends. Pull
telescoping nozzle (10), release headlamp
cleaning system switch, remove cover (9)
and release telescoping nozzle (10).
Unscrew screw (11)
Transfer AMG bumper
i See installation instructions for
accessories
Retrofit AMG paneling parts, model 208.3
coupe
Retrofit AMG paneling parts, model 208.4
convertible
Unscrew nuts (12) and remove bumper (1)
Installation
Position bumper (1) on body and slide guide
(13) onto holder (14) while inserting
centering pin (15) into holder (16)
Press bumper (1) up in area of wheelhouse
and fasten with rotary clip (7)
Start nuts (12) loosely on studs
Align bumper (1) with tip of fender (18) in
area of headlamp

Tighten screw (4)


Start screws (8) loosely

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar88.20-p-2000k, Removing and installing front bumper
MODEL 208

AZ88.00-P-0001B
AZ88.00-P-0001D

p Press against bumper (1) in area of


bumper guard and not on cover
i Bumper (1) should not extend more than 1
mm beyond tip of fender (18)
*BA88.20-P-1004-01A

216

Page 2 of 3

Push intermediate layer (17) outward to stop i This closes the gap between the bumper
(1) and cross member. Move intermediate
layer (17) with only slight force to prevent
bumper (1) from being pressed forward
Align bumper (1) to correct height and
tighten nuts (12)

18

19

*BA88.20-P-1001-01A
*129589032100

l
20
21

Tighten screws (8)


Screw in screw (11)

22
23
24
25

Install cover (9) on telescoping nozzle (10)


Plug in connector for fog lamp (3)
Install outside temperature sensor (5)
Install spreading rivet (6) in rear wheelhouse
panel
Install lining (2)

26

*BE88.20-P-1003-01A

*BA88.20-P-1003-01A
i The flange on the telescoping nozzle
(10) should make contact with the
reinforcement frame for the bumper (1)

Gap dimensions for bumper


Number

Designation

BE88.20-P-1003-01A

Di- Front bumper, gap dimension "C"


men (Headlamp lens to cover)
sion

Models 208.3/4

mm

AR88.20-P-2000K

See figure

n Bumper
Number

Designation

Models
208.3/4

BA88.20-P-1001-01A

Nut for front bumper on cross member

Nm

20

BA88.20-P-1003-01A

Bolt for front bumper on headlamp housing

Nm

BA88.20-P-1004-01A

Bolt for front bumper on inside of fender

Nm

129 589 03 21 00
Feeler gage

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar88.20-p-2000k, Removing and installing front bumper
MODEL 208

217

Page 3 of 3

AR68.10-P-1500K
MODEL
208
1
2
3
4
5
6

Removing and installing cover below instrument panel (left)

12.2.97

Cover
Plastic screw
Air outlet cover
Plastic nut
Screw
Handle

P68.10-0478-06

ed
1

Removal, installation
Turn plastic screw (2) 90 and remove air
outlet cover (3)
Unscrew screws (arrows) and plastic nut (4)

2
3
4

*140589010700

Pull cover (1) back and unscrew screw (5)


Unhook handle (6) from cover (1) and guide
through
Remove cover (1)
Reinstall in opposite order

5
6

140 589 01 07 00
Pin wrench

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar68.10-p-1500k, Removing and installing cover below instrument panel (left)
MODEL 208

218

Page 1 of 1

AR68.20-P-2000K
MODEL
208
1
2
3, 4, 5 and 6
7

Removing and installing center console

12.2.97

Center console
Cover (armrest)
Screws
Bottom section of
instrument panel

P68.20-0410-06

1
7

Center console
Bottom section of instrument panel

P68.20-0413-04

ed
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15

Removal, installation
Remove cover below instrument panel (left)
Remove cover below instrument panel (right)
Remove cover on air outlet in footwell on
left and right
Remove ashtray housing
Remove spectacles compartment
or cassette compartment
Remove radio
Remove pushbutton control module for
heater/air-conditioning
Open cover (2) above stowage compartment
and remove insert
Unscrew screws (3) in stowage
compartment
Unscrew screws (4) in area of shift lever
dome
Unscrew screws (5) below center nozzle
Unscrew screws (6) in bottom section of
instrument panel on left and right
Lift floor covering in front in area of center
console paneling
Adjust both front seats to rear
Remove center console (1) toward rear by
lifting side covers over air outlet ducts and
seat adjustment rails, then pull center
console (1) below bottom sections of
instrument panel

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar68.20-p-2000k, Removing and installing center console
MODEL 208

AR68.10-P-1500K
AR68.10-P-1520K

AR68.20-P-2400K
AR68.20-P-2450K
AR82.60-P-7502EA

219

Page 1 of 2

16

Reinstall in opposite order

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar68.20-p-2000k, Removing and installing center console
MODEL 208

220

Page 2 of 2

AR72.10-P-0550G
MODEL
170, 208.3

Adjust front door

25.11.09

P72.10-0267-09

Shown on model 170


1
2

1
2

5
6

9
10
11

3
4
5
6

Screw
Lock striker

Screw
Centering screw
Screw
Hinge

Adjust
Remove lock striker (2)
Inspect sizes of gaps at door all round

7
8

l Centering gage
l Depth stop

*129589032100
l
Model 170
AR60.00-P-0700-01G
Gap dimensions on hoods, doors and covers
*BE60.00-P-1002-01A
*BE60.00-P-1006-01A
Model 208.3
AR60.00-P-0700-01K
Gap dimensions on hoods, doors and covers
*BE60.00-P-1002-01A
*BA72.10-P-1001-01A
n

Loosen bolts (3) from inner door panel and


tighten; adjust gap dimension by moving front
door
Loosen bolts (5) and tighten; with centering n
screw (4) on hinge (6), adjust contour of
i Door paneling should be flush with
driver door at hinge side
contour of front fender or should be located
max. 1 mm deeper.
Bolt on striker eye (2).
i Do not tighten bolts (1)
Insert centering gage (7) into door lock until
lock completely catches (catch stage 2)

*BA72.10-P-1001-01A

l Left centering gage

*210589022100

l Right centering gage

*210589032100

Position depth stop (8) at height of striker


l
eye (2) on outside door panel and close
door until depth stop (8) makes contact on
both sides (arrows)
Press striker eye (2) into centering gage (7) n
from inside through open window and tighten
bolts (1)
Pull outer door handle and remove centering
gage (7)
Check door for easy motion
Check crank window adjustment, if
Model 170
necessary adjust
Model 208.3

*124589032100

*BA72.10-P-1004-01A

AR72.10-P-1950G
AR72.10-P-1950K

Test and adjustment values, gap dimensions at hoods, doors and covers
Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar72.10-p-0550g, Adjust front door
MODEL 170, 208.3

221

Page 1 of 2

Number

Designation

Type
170

Type
208.3

BE60.00-P-1002-01A

Gap
Front door to A-pillar
dimension

Dimension
"B"

mm

6.5 ( 0.5)

Front door to fender

Dimension
"H"

mm

4.0 ( 0.5)

4.0 ( 0.5)

Front door to rear door

Dimension
"I"

mm

Front door to roof

Dimension
"C"

mm

Rear door to top of side section

Dimension
"D"

mm

Rear door to side section, bottom

Dimension
"J"

mm

Fender to A-pillar

Dimension
"Q"

mm

4.0 ( 1.6)

Front door to rear fender

Dimension
"P"

mm

4.0 ( 0.5)

4.0 ( 0.5)

AR60.00-P-0700-01G

AR60.00-P-0700-01K

See picture
BE60.00-P-1006-01A

Gap
Roof to windshield frame
dimension
Roof to rear window frame

Dimension
"S"

mm

9.0 (+0/-2)

Dimension
"T"

mm

7.0 (+0/-2)

AR60.00-P-0700-01G

See picture

n Front door
Number

Designation

BA72.10-P-1001-01A

Screw on door hinge

BA72.10-P-1004-01A

Bolt to lock striker

124 589 03 21 00
Depth stop

129 589 03 21 00
Feeler gauge

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar72.10-p-0550g, Adjust front door


MODEL 170, 208.3

Model
170

Model
208.3/4

Nm

32

37

Nm

28

28

210 589 02 21 00
Left centering gage

210 589 03 21 00
Right centering gage

222

Page 2 of 2

AR80.57-P-1000K
MODEL
208
1

Removing and installing electronic ignition/starter switch control module

3.12.96

Round cover plate


2
Shift lock control cable
3
Electrical connector
N73
Electronic ignition switch
control module
210 589 00 07 00

P82.57-0235-06

ed
1

Removal, installation
Remove bottom section of instrument panel
(on driver-side)
Screw off round cover plate (1)
with special tool
Pull electronic ignition switch control module
(N73) toward rear out of cover below left
side of instrument panel
Remove shift lock control cable (2) on
electronic ignition switch control module
(N73)
Disconnect electrical connectors (3) from
electronic ignition switch control module
(N73)
Reinstall in opposite order

2
3

AR68.10-P-1505K
l

*210589000700

i only on vehicles with


automatic transmission
i Use aid for connection and disconnection
if required
i Installation: When replacing electronic
ignition switch control module (N73) program
according to programming instructions
included with programming station.

210 589 00 07 00
Claw-type wrench for round cover plate on
ignition/starter switch

Daimler AG, 8/7/15, G/04/14, ar80.57-p-1000k, Removing and installing electronic ignition/starter switch control module
MODEL 208

223

Page 1 of 1

AR82.10-P-1201B
Remove/install bulbs of headlamp unit
MODEL
208,
210 up to 31.5.99 with CODE (612) Xenon headlamp unit

6.4.95

Model 208
1
14
15
16
E1n2
E2n2

Housing cover
Bolts
Nut
Xenon lamp D2R
Xenon headlamp ignition module
Xenon headlamp ignition module

P82.10-0752-06

Model 210
1
15
16
E1n2
E2n2

Housing cover
Nut
Xenon lamp D2R
Xenon headlamp ignition module
Xenon headlamp ignition module

P82.10-0313-06

ed

Remove/install

a Danger!

Risk of death caused by touching parts


which conduct high voltages

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar82.10-p-1201b, Remove/install bulbs of headlamp unit


MODEL 208, 210 up to 31.5.99 with CODE (612) Xenon headlamp unit

Do not come into contact with parts that are AS15.10-Z-0001-01A


under high voltage. Persons who have
electronic implants (e.g. pacemakers) must
not perform any work on the ignition system.

224

Page 1 of 2

a Danger!

1
2.1
2.2
3
4
5

Risk of death caused by high voltage levels


present at xenon headlamps.
Risk of explosion/risk of fire due to highly
flammable materials in the area of damaged
xenon bulbs
Risk of injury from UV light, hot
components at xenon headlamps and glass
splinters when xenon bulbs crack
Risk of poisoning from inhaling mercury
vapors and from swallowing/skin contact with
poisonous salts and mercury compounds
Remove lamp unit
Unscrew screws (14) and remove housing
cover (1)
Unclip housing cover (1)
Unscrew nuts (15) and remove ignition
modules (E1n2, E2n2)
Carefully remove xenon bulb D2R (16)
Install in the reverse order

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar82.10-p-1201b, Remove/install bulbs of headlamp unit


MODEL 208, 210 up to 31.5.99 with CODE (612) Xenon headlamp unit

Do not come into contact with parts that are AS82.10-Z-0001-01A


under high voltage. Persons with active
electronic implants (e.g. heart pacemakers)
must never work on xenon headlamps.
Switch off entire lighting system. Wear
insulating safety shoes, safety glasses and
protective gloves. Remove highly
inflammable materials from the hazard area.
Ensure the work area is adequately
ventilated.
Model 208
Model 210
Model 208

AR82.10-P-4730EE
AR82.10-P-4730EB

Model 210

225

Page 2 of 2

AR82.15-P-6100K
Removing and installing telescoping nozzle for headlamp cleaning system
MODEL
208 with CODE (600a) Headlamp cleaning system

29.1.97

P82.15-0244-09

9
10

Telescoping nozzle
Cover

9
15

Telescoping nozzle
Retaining lug

11
12

Screw
Retaining clip

13
14

Washing water hose


Mount

P82.15-0245-01

ed
1
2
3
4
5

6
7

Removal, installation
Open engine hood,
move to upright position
Pull cover (10) toward front and unclip
telescoping nozzle (9)
Unscrew screw (11)
Disconnect washing water hose (13)
with clamp
Pull off retaining clip (12) and remove
washing water hose (13) from telescoping
nozzle (9)
Remove mount (14) (2 screws)

AR88.40-P-1000F
p Avoid damaging paint on cover and
bumper
l

*000589403700

i Installation: Ensure that centering hole


is properly positioned (arrow)

Remove telescoping nozzle (9) from bumper p Avoid damaging paint on bumper
toward front
i Installation: The retaining lug (15) must
be inserted into the headlamp housing

8
9

Reinstall in opposite order


Check for proper function

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar82.15-p-6100k, Removing and installing telescoping nozzle for headlamp cleaning system
MODEL 208 with CODE (600a) Headlamp cleaning system

226

Page 1 of 2

000 589 40 37 00
Clamp

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar82.15-p-6100k, Removing and installing telescoping nozzle for headlamp cleaning system
MODEL 208 with CODE (600a) Headlamp cleaning system

227

Page 2 of 2

AR82.15-P-6200K
Removing and installing headlamp cleaning system washing water reservoir
MODEL
208 with CODE (600a) Headlamp cleaning system

29.1.97

P82.15-0249-07

1
2

Hot water hose


Clamp

ed
1
2

3
4

Connector
Plastic nut

M5/1 Windshield washer pump


M5/2 Headlamp washer pump

Removal, installation

Move engine hood to upright position


Disconnect connector (3) on washing water
indicator
Attach clamp (2) to hot water hoses (1)
for washing water heating spiral
Remove hot water hoses (1) and unclip
washing water reservoir
Unscrew plastic nuts (4) and remove
washing water reservoir from mount
Remove windshield washer pump (M5/1) and
unclip feed lines from washing water
reservoir
Remove headlamp washer pump (M5/2)

8
9

Remove washing water reservoir upward


Reinstall in opposite order

3
4
5
6

AR88.40-P-1000F

*000589403700

i Plug opening in washing water reservoir


with suitable plug
i Plug opening in washing water reservoir
with suitable plug

000 589 40 37 00
Clamp

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar82.15-p-6200k, Removing and installing headlamp cleaning system washing water reservoir
MODEL 208 with CODE (600a) Headlamp cleaning system

228

Page 1 of 1

AR82.20-P-1000K
Removing and installing overhead control panel control module
MODEL
202 as of 1.6.97,
208,
210 as of 1.3.97
1

27.11.96

Light lenses
N70 Overhead control
panel control module

P82.20-0312-06

ed
1
2
3
4
5

Removal, installation
Pry out lenses (1)
Press in clips (arrows)
Pry out overhead control panel control
module (N70) toward front
Disconnect electrical connectors on overhead
control panel control module (N70)
Reinstall in opposite order

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar82.20-p-1000k, Removing and installing overhead control panel control module
MODEL 202 as of 1.6.97, 208, 210 as of 1.3.97

229

Page 1 of 1

AR82.30-P-7700F
Remove/install rain sensor
MODELS 129,
202 as of 1.6.97,
208, 210 with CODE (345a) Rain sensor

16.1.95

Shown on Model 210


1
2
3

Cover
Retaining clips
Lens

B38 Rain sensor

P82.30-0211-06

Modification notes
11.4.03

ed
1
2
3
4

5
6
7

Disconnecting ground lead from battery newly included

Step 1

Remove/Install
Disconnect ground cable of battery
Remove cover (1)
Release retaining clamps (2) from rain
sensor (B38) on left and right
Remove rain sensor (B38)

AR54.10-P-0003A

p Lens (3) of rain sensor (B38) is bonded


to the windshield and may not be removed,
otherwise this damages the lens (3).

Separate electrical connector at rain sensor


(B38)
Install in the reverse order
Check for proper function

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar82.30-p-7700f, Remove/install rain sensor


MODELS 129, 202 as of 1.6.97, 208, 210 with CODE (345a) Rain sensor

230

Page 1 of 1

AR68.30-P-4580K
MODEL
208.3
1
2
3

Removing, disassembling and installing rear shelf

12.2.97

Rear shelf
Expanding anchor
Connector for center high-mounted
stop lamp

P68.30-0497-04

1
2
3
4
5
6

Rear shelf
Reinforcement frame
Indicator
Housing
Center high-mounted stop lamp
Speaker cover

P68.30-0503-06

1
2
3
4
5
6

Rear shelf
Reinforcement frame
Indicator
Housing
Center high-mounted stop lamp
Speaker cover

P68.30-0504-06

Removal

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar68.30-p-4580k, Removing, disassembling and installing rear shelf
MODEL 208.3

231

Page 1 of 2

1
2
3

5
d
6
7

9
10
11
c
12
13
14
15
16
17

Remove side paneling in rear on left


and right
Remove both rear head restraints
Remove expanding anchor (2)

AR68.30-P-4780K
AR91.16-P-1770E
i On vehicles with code 540a also
unscrew nuts (3 each) on sun blind and
disconnect connector from drive

Lift rear shelf (1) at front and pull forward by


simultaneously disconnecting connector (3)
on center high-mounted stop lamp
Remove rear shelf (1)
Installation
Position insulation below rear shelf (1) and
expose wires
Position rear shelf (1) and simultaneously
connect connector (3) to center highmounted stop lamp.
Insert lugs on rear shelf (1) (arrows) into
cutouts in trunk bridge and insert indicator
(3) into opening above backrest catch
Install expanding anchor (2)

i On vehicles with code 540a connect


connector to drive for sun blind

i On vehicles with code 540a also screw


nuts ( 3 each ) onto sun blind

Install both rear headrests


Install side paneling on left and right
Disassembly

AR91.16-P-1770E
AR68.30-P-4780K

Lay rear shelf (1) down on suitable surface


Unclip indicator (3) (arrow) and remove
Remove reinforcement frame (2)
Push housing (4) toward rear and unclip
from rear shelf (1) (arrow)
Unclip center high-mounted stop lamp (5)
toward rear (arrow) and remove
Unclip speaker cover (6) and remove
upward

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar68.30-p-4580k, Removing, disassembling and installing rear shelf
MODEL 208.3

232

Page 2 of 2

AP83.00-P-8381A
MODEL
208

Replacing dust filter for heating/ventilation

17.7.97

Left figure
2 Cover
3 Retaining clips
Right figure
1 Dust filter

P83.10-0203-01

ed
1
2
3
4

P83.10-0200-01

Removing, installing
Remove cover panel below instrument panel i If automatic air conditioning (Auto AC)
fitted, a combination filter is used
Take off cover (2)
Push the two retaining clips (3) in direction
of arrow for this purpose
Pull dust filter (1) down and out (arrows)
Install in the reverse order

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ap83.00-p-8381a, Replacing dust filter for heating/ventilation
MODEL 208

AR68.10-P-1520K

233

Page 1 of 1

AR83.25-P-1200G
MODEL
170,
202 as of 1.9.95,
208

Removing and installing blower motor

9.4.96

Illustrated in model 170


4
5
6
8
A32m1
N29

Electrical lead, positive


Electrical lead, negative
Screw
Screw
Blower motor
Electronic blower regulator

P83.25-2033-04

ed
1
2
3
4

Removal, installation
Remove electronic blower regulator (N29)
Unscrew screws (6)
Remove blower motor (A32m1)
Install in opposite order

Daimler AG, 8/9/15, G/04/14, ar83.25-p-1200g, Removing and installing blower motor
MODEL 170, 202 as of 1.9.95, 208

AR83.25-P-1220G

234

Page 1 of 1

You might also like